Flash, FRAM and EEPROM driver for STM32 QUAD-/OCTOSPI interface
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex zy1000
302 @cindex printer port
303 @cindex USB Adapter
304 @cindex RTCK
305
306 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
307 an adapter .... [snip]
308
309 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
310 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
311 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
312 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
313 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
314 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
315 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
316
317
318 @section Choosing a Dongle
319
320 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
321
322 @enumerate
323 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
324 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
325 other ways to communicate with target devices.
326 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
327 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
328 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
329 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
330 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
331 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
332 Ethernet port needed?
333 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
334 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
335 @end enumerate
336
337 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
338
339 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
340 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
341 running on the developer's host computer.
342 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
343 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
344 IP address assigned to the probe.
345 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
346 OpenOCD debugger.
347 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
348 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
349 the target.
350 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
351 to power cycle the target remotely.
352
353 For more information, visit:
354
355 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
356
357 @section USB FT2232 Based
358
359 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
360 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
361 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
362 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
363 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
364 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
365 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
366 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
367 clocking.)
368
369 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
370 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
371 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
372 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
373 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
374
375 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
376 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
377
378 @itemize @bullet
379 @item @b{usbjtag}
380 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
381 @item @b{jtagkey}
382 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
383 @item @b{jtagkey2}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
385 @item @b{oocdlink}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
387 @item @b{signalyzer}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
389 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
391 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
392 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
393 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
394 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
395 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
396 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
397 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
398 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
399 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
400 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
401 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
402 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
404 @item @b{turtelizer2}
405 @* See:
406 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
407 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
408 @item @b{comstick}
409 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
410 @item @b{stm32stick}
411 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
412 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
413 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
414 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
415 @item @b{cortino}
416 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
417 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
419 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
421 @item @b{opendous}
422 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
423 (OpenHardware).
424 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
425 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
426
427 @item @b{GW16042}
428 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
429 FT2232H-based
430
431 @end itemize
432 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
433
434 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
435 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
436 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
437 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
438 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
439
440 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
441 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
442 (see the section on driver commands).
443
444 @itemize
445 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
446 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
447 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
448 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
449 @end itemize
450
451 @section USB J-Link based
452 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
453 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
454 AT91SAM764 internally.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
458 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
459 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
461 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
462 @end itemize
463
464 @section USB RLINK based
465 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
466 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
467 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
468
469 @itemize @bullet
470 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
472 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
476 @end itemize
477
478 @section USB ST-LINK based
479 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
480 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
481
482 @itemize @bullet
483 @item @b{ST-LINK}
484 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
485 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
486 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
489 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
508 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
509 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
510 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
511 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
512
513 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
514 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
515 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
516
517 @section USB Other
518 @itemize @bullet
519 @item @b{USBprog}
520 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
521
522 @item @b{USB - Presto}
523 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
524
525 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
526 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
527
528 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
529 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
530
531 @item @b{Buspirate}
532 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
533
534 @item @b{opendous}
535 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
536
537 @item @b{estick}
538 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
539
540 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
541 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
542
543 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
544 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
546 @end itemize
547
548 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
549
550 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
551 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
552 these on the market.
553
554 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
555 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
556 of USB-based ones.
557
558 @itemize @bullet
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
562
563 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
564 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
565 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
566
567 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler2}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
574 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
575
576 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
577 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
578
579 @item @b{arm-jtag}
580 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
581
582 @item @b{chameleon}
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
584
585 @item @b{Triton}
586 @* Unknown.
587
588 @item @b{Lattice}
589 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
590 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
591
592 @item @b{flashlink}
593 @* From STMicroelectronics;
594 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
595
596 @end itemize
597
598 @section Other...
599 @itemize @bullet
600
601 @item @b{ep93xx}
602 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
603
604 @item @b{at91rm9200}
605 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
606
607 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
608 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
609
610 @item @b{imx_gpio}
611 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
612
613 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
614 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
615 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
616
617 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
618 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
619 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
620 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
621 emulation model of target hardware.
622
623 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
624 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
625
626 @end itemize
627
628 @node About Jim-Tcl
629 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
630 @cindex Jim-Tcl
631 @cindex tcl
632
633 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
634 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
635 command interpreter.
636
637 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
638 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
639 much of anything about Tcl.
640 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
641
642 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
643 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
644 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
645 OpenOCD mailing list.
646
647 @itemize @bullet
648 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
649 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
650 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
651 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
652 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
653 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
654
655 @item @b{Missing Features}
656 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
657 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
658 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
659 enabled in OpenOCD.
660
661 @item @b{Scripts}
662 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
663 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
664 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
665
666 @item @b{Commands}
667 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
668 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
669 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
670 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
671
672 @item @b{Historical Note}
673 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
674 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
675 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
676 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
677
678 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
679 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
680 @end itemize
681
682 @node Running
683 @chapter Running
684 @cindex command line options
685 @cindex logfile
686 @cindex directory search
687
688 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
689 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
690 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
691 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
692 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
693 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
694 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
695
696 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
697 tell it how each debug session should work.
698 The @option{--help} option shows:
699 @verbatim
700 bash$ openocd --help
701
702 --help | -h display this help
703 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
704 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
705 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
706 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
707 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
708 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
709 --command | -c run <command>
710 @end verbatim
711
712 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
713 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
714 To specify one or more different
715 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
716
717 @example
718 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
719 @end example
720
721 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
722 @enumerate
723 @item the current directory,
724 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
725 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
726 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
727 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
728 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
729 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
730 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
731 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
732 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
733 @end enumerate
734 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
735
736 @quotation Note
737 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
738 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
739 @end quotation
740
741 @section Simple setup, no customization
742
743 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
744 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
745 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
746 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
747 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
748
749 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
750 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
751 the server with some variation of one of the following:
752
753 @example
754 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
755 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
756 @end example
757
758 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
759 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
760 If all goes well you'll see output something like
761
762 @example
763 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
764 For bug reports, read
765 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
766 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
767 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
768 @end example
769
770 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
771 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
772 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
773
774 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
775
776 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
777 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
778 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
779 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
780 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
781 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
782 ensure that this always succeeds.
783 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
784 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
785 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
786 and then shut down without acting as a server.
787
788 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
789 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
790 those channels.
791
792 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
793 the @option{-d} option.
794
795 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
796 @option{-c} command line switch.
797
798 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
799 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
800 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
801 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
802 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
803 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
804 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
805
806 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
807 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
808
809 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
810 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
811 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
812 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
813
814 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
815 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
816
817 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
818 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
819 and start the OpenOCD server.
820 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
821 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
822 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
823 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
824
825 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
826
827 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
828 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
829 and a USB cable on the other.
830 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
831 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
832
833 @enumerate
834 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
835 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
836 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
837 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
838 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
839 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
840 debugging host.
841
842 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
843 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
844 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
845 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
846 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
847
848 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
849 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
850 with 1.2 Volt boards.
851
852 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
853 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
854 ways to connect the cable.
855 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
856 Be sure it's firmly connected.
857
858 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
859 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
860 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
861 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
862 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
863 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
864 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
865 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
866
867 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
868 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
869 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
870 but are tedious to set up.
871 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
872 adapter signals to the right board pins.
873
874 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
875 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
876 you are using to run OpenOCD.
877 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
878
879 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
880 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
881 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
882 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
883
884 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
885 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
886 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
887
888 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
889 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
890 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
891 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
892
893 @end enumerate
894
895 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
896 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
897 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
898
899 @section Project Directory
900
901 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
902
903 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
904 single directory for your work with a given board.
905 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
906 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
907 files accessed through semihosting,
908 and for code you upload to the target board.
909 It is also the natural place to write files,
910 such as log files and data you download from the board.
911
912 @section Configuration Basics
913
914 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
915 a variety of ways you can mix them.
916 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
917
918 @itemize
919 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
920 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
921 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
922 @end itemize
923
924 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
925 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
926 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
927
928 @example
929 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
930
931 # GDB can also flash my flash!
932 gdb_memory_map enable
933 gdb_flash_program enable
934
935 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
936 @end example
937
938 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
939
940 @example
941 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
942 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
943 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
944 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
945 @end example
946
947 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
948 each supporting a different development task.
949 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
950 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
951
952 @quotation Important
953 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
954 problems with how it treats variables.
955 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
956 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
957 that can be tested in a later script.
958 @end quotation
959
960 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
961 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
962 to simplify your work.
963
964 @section User Config Files
965 @cindex config file, user
966 @cindex user config file
967 @cindex config file, overview
968
969 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
970 in one place.
971 One of the following will match your situation best:
972
973 @itemize
974 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
975 provided by someone else.
976 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
977 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
978 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
979 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
980 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
981 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
982
983 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
984 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
985
986 @enumerate
987 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
988 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
989 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
990 @end enumerate
991
992 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
993 The first is an interface config file.
994 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
995 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
996 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
997 meet your deadline:
998
999 @example
1000 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1001 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1002 @end example
1003
1004 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1005 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1006 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1007 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1008
1009 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1010 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1011 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1012 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1013 target and board
1014 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1015 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1016
1017 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1018 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1019 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1020 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1021
1022 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1023 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1024 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1025 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1026 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1027
1028 @quotation Note
1029 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1030 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1031 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1032 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1033 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1034 @end quotation
1035
1036 @item
1037 You may need to write some C code.
1038 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1039 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1040 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1041 a new chip architecture.
1042 @end itemize
1043
1044 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1045 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1046 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1047
1048 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1049 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1050 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1051 @itemize
1052
1053 @item
1054 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1055 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1056 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1057 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1058
1059 @item
1060 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1061 @cindex vector_catch
1062 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1063 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1064 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1065 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1066 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1067 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1068
1069 @item
1070 You might need to override some defaults.
1071 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1072 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1073
1074 @item
1075 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1076 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1077 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1078 @end itemize
1079
1080 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1081
1082 A few project-specific utility
1083 routines may well speed up your work.
1084 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1085
1086 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1087 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1088 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1089 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1090 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1091 may help:
1092
1093 @example
1094 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1095 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1096 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1097 # Leave the CPU halted.
1098 reset init
1099
1100 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1101 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1102
1103 # Start running.
1104 resume 0x20000000
1105 @}
1106 @end example
1107
1108 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1109 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1110 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1111 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1112 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1113
1114 @example
1115 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1116 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1117 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1118 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1119 reset init
1120
1121 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1122 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1123 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1124 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1125 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1126 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1127 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1128
1129 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1130 reset run
1131 @}
1132 @end example
1133
1134 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1135 from NAND.
1136 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1137 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1138 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1139
1140 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1141 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1142
1143 @section Target Software Changes
1144
1145 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1146 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1147 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1148 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1149 handling issues like:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152
1153 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1154 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1155 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1156 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1157 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1158 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1159 your debug sessions.
1160
1161 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1162 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1163 That might however be your only option.
1164
1165 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1166 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1167 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1168 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1169 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1170 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1171 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1172 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1173 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1174 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1175 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1176 instead of the whole thing.
1177 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1178 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1179
1180 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1181 @cindex ARM semihosting
1182 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1183 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1184 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1185 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1186 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1187 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1188 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1189 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1190 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1191 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1192 NAND or SPI flash.
1193
1194 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1195 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1196 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1197 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1198 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1199
1200 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1201 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1202 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1203 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1204 registers which can be used to change various features including
1205 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1206 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1207 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1208 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1209 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1210
1211 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1212 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1213 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1214 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1215 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1216
1217 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1218 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1219 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1220 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1221 early code execution can be debugged
1222 or firmware can be replaced.
1223
1224 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1225 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1226 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1227 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1228 operations like writing to memory.)
1229
1230 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1231 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1232 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1233 various kinds of message.
1234 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1235
1236 @end itemize
1237
1238 @section Target Hardware Setup
1239
1240 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1241 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1242 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1243 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1244 working with.}
1245
1246 Common issues include:
1247
1248 @itemize @bullet
1249
1250 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1251 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1252 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1253 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1254 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1255 or one from a daughtercard).
1256 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1257 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1258
1259 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1260 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1261 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1262 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1263 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1264 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1265
1266 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1267 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1268 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1269 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1270 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1271
1272
1273 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1274 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1275 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1276 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1277 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1278 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1279 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1280
1281 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1282 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1283 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1284 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1285 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1286
1287 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1288 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1289 used to start booting.
1290
1291 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1292 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1293 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1294 multiple audio codec chips).
1295 This interacts with software
1296 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1297 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1298 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1299 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1300 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1301 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1302 audio or video codecs are used.
1303
1304 @end itemize
1305
1306 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1307 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1308 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1309 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1310 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1311 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1312 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1313 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1314 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1315 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1316
1317
1318 @node Config File Guidelines
1319 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1320
1321 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1322 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1323 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1324 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1325
1326 You should find the following directories under
1327 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1328 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1329 @itemize @bullet
1330 @item @file{interface} ...
1331 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1332 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1333 @item @file{board} ...
1334 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1335 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1336
1337 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1338 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1339 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1340 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1341 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1342 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1343 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1344 a CPU and an FPGA.
1345 @item @file{target} ...
1346 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1347 on a chip
1348 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1349 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1350 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1351 the target config file defines all of them.
1352 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1353 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1354 @end itemize
1355
1356 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1357 file may override features in any of the above files by
1358 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1359 commands specific to their situation.
1360
1361 @section Interface Config Files
1362
1363 The user config file
1364 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1365
1366 @example
1367 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1368 @end example
1369
1370 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1371 in use today with OpenOCD.
1372 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1373 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1374
1375 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1376 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1377 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1378 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1379 and need to provide a driver for it.
1380
1381 @section Board Config Files
1382 @cindex config file, board
1383 @cindex board config file
1384
1385 The user config file
1386 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1387
1388 @example
1389 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1390 @end example
1391
1392 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1393 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1394 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1395
1396 @enumerate
1397 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1398 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1399 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1400 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1401 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1402 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1403 @end enumerate
1404
1405 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1406 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1407 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1408 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1409
1410 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1411 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1412 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1413 configuration works.
1414
1415 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1416
1417 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1418 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1419 convention on how to use certain variables.
1420
1421 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1422 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1423 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1424 used at will within a target configuration file.
1425
1426 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1427 for a board with three chips:
1428
1429 @example
1430 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1431 set CHIPNAME network
1432 set ENDIAN big
1433 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1434 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1435 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1436 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1437
1438 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1439 set CHIPNAME video
1440 set ENDIAN little
1441 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1442 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1443 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1444 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1445
1446 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1447 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1448 unset ENDIAN
1449 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1450 @end example
1451
1452 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1453 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1454 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1455 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1456 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1457 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1458 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1459 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1460
1461 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1462 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1463 naming collisions.
1464
1465 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1466 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1467 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1468 up other clocks and peripherals.
1469
1470 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1471 @cindex variable names
1472
1473 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1474 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1475 one such chip (as shown above).
1476 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1477 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1478 to promote consistency and
1479 so that board files can override target defaults.
1480
1481 Inputs to target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1485 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1486 tap identifier dotted names.
1487 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1488 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1489 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1490 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1491 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1492 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1493 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1494 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1495 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1496 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1497 @end itemize
1498
1499 Outputs from target config files include:
1500
1501 @itemize @bullet
1502 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1503 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1504 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1505 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1506 specific to that board and that target.
1507 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1508 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1512 @cindex event, reset-init
1513 @cindex reset-init handler
1514
1515 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1516 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1517 fully set up yet.
1518 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1519 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1520 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1521 handler is one of the most important.
1522
1523 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1524 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1525 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1526 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1527 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1528
1529 @quotation Note
1530 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1531 are included here.
1532 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1533 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1534 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1535 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1536 @end quotation
1537
1538 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1539 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1540 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1541 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1542 those as parameters.
1543 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1544 and disabling the watchdog.
1545 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1546 the next developer doing such work.
1547 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1548
1549 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1550 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1551 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1552 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1553
1554 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1555
1556 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1557 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1558 a low JTAG clock rate.
1559 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1560 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1561 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1562 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1563 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1564 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1565 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1566
1567 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1568 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1569 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1570 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1571 which might be less than that.
1572
1573 @quotation Warning
1574 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1575 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1576 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1577 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1578 @end quotation
1579
1580 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1581 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1582 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1583 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1584 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1585 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1586
1587 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1588 @subsection The init_board procedure
1589 @cindex init_board procedure
1590
1591 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1592 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1593 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1594 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1595 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1596 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1597 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1598 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1599 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1600 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1601 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1602 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1603
1604 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1605 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1606
1607 @example
1608 ### board_file.cfg ###
1609
1610 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1611 source [find target/target.cfg]
1612
1613 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1614 # enables fast on-board clock source
1615 # configures the chip to use it
1616 @}
1617
1618 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1619 proc init_board @{@} @{
1620 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1621
1622 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1623 adapter speed 100
1624 @}
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1627 enable_fast_clock
1628 adapter speed 10000
1629 @}
1630 @}
1631 @end example
1632
1633 @section Target Config Files
1634 @cindex config file, target
1635 @cindex target config file
1636
1637 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1638 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1639 more target config files like this:
1640
1641 @example
1642 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1643 @end example
1644
1645 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1646 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1647 In summary the target files should contain
1648
1649 @enumerate
1650 @item Set defaults
1651 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1652 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1653 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1654 @item On-Chip flash
1655 @end enumerate
1656
1657 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1658 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1659 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1660
1661 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1662 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1663 can talk to the chip.
1664 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1665 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1666 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1667 and other processing engines.
1668
1669 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1670
1671 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1672 letting board config files express environment-specific
1673 differences in how things should be set up.
1674
1675 @example
1676 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1677 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1678 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1679 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1680 @} else @{
1681 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1682 @}
1683
1684 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1685 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1686 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _ENDIAN little
1689 @}
1690
1691 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1692 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1693 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1694 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1695 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1696 @} else @{
1697 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1698 @}
1699 @end example
1700 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1701
1702 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1703 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1704 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1705
1706 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1707 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1708 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1709
1710 @example
1711 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1712 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1713 @end example
1714
1715 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1716 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1717 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1718 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1719 for taps.
1720
1721 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1722 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1723 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1724 looks (in part) like this:
1725
1726 @example
1727 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1728 @end example
1729
1730 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1731 to source such a config file twice, with different
1732 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1733 it adds a different TAP each time.
1734
1735 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1736 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1737 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1738 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1739
1740 @example
1741 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1742 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1743 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1744 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1745 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1746 @end example
1747
1748 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1749 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1750
1751 @itemize
1752 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1753 plus a JRC to enable them
1754 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1755 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1756 is not currently used)
1757 @end itemize
1758
1759 @subsection Add CPU targets
1760
1761 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1762 GDB and other commands can use it.
1763 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1764 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1765 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1766 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1767
1768 @example
1769 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1770 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1771 @end example
1772
1773 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1774 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1775 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1776 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1777 a work area if you can.
1778 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1779
1780 @example
1781 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1782 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1783 @end example
1784
1785 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1786 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1787 @cindex SMP
1788 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1789
1790 @example
1791 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1792 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1793 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1794 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1795 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1796 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1797 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1798 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 @end example
1800 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1801 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1802 @itemize @bullet
1803 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1804 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1805 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1806 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1807 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1808 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1809 @end itemize
1810
1811 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1812 command have been implemented.
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1815 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1816 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1817 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1818 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1819 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1820 following example.
1821 @end itemize
1822
1823 @example
1824 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1826 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1830 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1832 > resume
1833 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1834 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1835 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1836 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1840 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1841 @end example
1842
1843
1844 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1845
1846 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1847 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1848 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1849
1850 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1851 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1852 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1853 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1854 both signals.
1855
1856 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1857 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1858 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1859 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1860 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1861 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1862 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1863 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1864 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1865 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1866 not available.)
1867
1868 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1869 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1870 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1871 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1872 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1873 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1874 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1875 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1876
1877 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1878 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1879 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1880 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1881 slower clock than they will use later.
1882 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1883 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1884 than they will use later.
1885 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1886
1887 @quotation Important
1888 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1889 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1890 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1891 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1892 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1893 @end quotation
1894
1895 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1896 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1897 @cindex init_targets procedure
1898
1899 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1900 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1901 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1902 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1903 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1904 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1905 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1906 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1907 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1908
1909 @example
1910 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1911
1912 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1913 # basic initialization procedure ...
1914 @}
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1919 @}
1920
1921 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1924
1925 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1926 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1927 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1928 @}
1929 @end example
1930
1931 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1932 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1933
1934 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1935
1936 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1938
1939 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1940 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1941 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1942
1943 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1944 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1945 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1946 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1947 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1948 events already assigned.
1949
1950 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1951
1952 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1953 special high speed download features - enable it.
1954
1955 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1956
1957 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1958 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1959 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1960 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1961 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1962 If you are using an external trace port,
1963 configure it in your board config file.
1964 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1965 configure it in your target config file.
1966
1967 @example
1968 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1969 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1970 @end example
1971
1972 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1973
1974 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1975
1976 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1977 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1978 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1979 the TARGET (chip) file.
1980
1981 Examples:
1982 @itemize @bullet
1983 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1984 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1985 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1986 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1987 @end itemize
1988
1989 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1990 @section Translating Configuration Files
1991 @cindex translation
1992 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1993 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1994 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1995 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1996 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1997 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1998
1999 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2000 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2001 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2002 convert other scripts later on.
2003
2004 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2005 replace job:
2006
2007 @example
2008 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2009 #
2010 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2011 #
2012 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2013 #
2014 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2015
2016 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2017 global TARGETNAME
2018
2019 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2020
2021 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2022 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2023 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2024 @}
2025 @end example
2026
2027
2028
2029 @node Server Configuration
2030 @chapter Server Configuration
2031 @cindex initialization
2032 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2033 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2034 supported.
2035
2036 @anchor{configurationstage}
2037 @section Configuration Stage
2038 @cindex configuration stage
2039 @cindex config command
2040
2041 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2042 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2043 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2044 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2045 inside startup scripts.
2046
2047 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2048 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2049 which may be issued interactively.
2050 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2051 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2052
2053 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2054 flash banks,
2055 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2056 and other basic setup.
2057 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2058 may access or activate TAPs.
2059 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2060 longer be issued.
2061
2062 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2063 @section Entering the Run Stage
2064
2065 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2066 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2067 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2068 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2069 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2070 You should see no errors at this point.
2071 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2072 commands you used to configure the server.
2073 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2074 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2075 on the scan chain.
2076
2077 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2078 become available.
2079 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2080 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2081 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2082 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2083 entry to the run stage.
2084
2085 @deffn {Config Command} init
2086 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2087 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2088 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2089 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2090 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2091 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2092
2093 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2094 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2095 configuration files and/or command line options.
2096
2097 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2098 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2099 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2100 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2101 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2102 @end deffn
2103
2104 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2105 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2106 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2107
2108 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2109 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2110 scan chain.
2111 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2112 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2113
2114 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2115 they return.
2116 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2117 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2118 @end deffn
2119
2120 @anchor{tcpipports}
2121 @section TCP/IP Ports
2122 @cindex TCP port
2123 @cindex server
2124 @cindex port
2125 @cindex security
2126 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2127 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2128 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2129
2130 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2131 access using one or more of these ports.
2132 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2133 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2134 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2135
2136 @anchor{gdb_port}
2137 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2138 @cindex GDB server
2139 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2140 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2141 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2142 the normal use cases.
2143
2144 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2145 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2146 disables the gdb server.
2147
2148 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2149 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2150
2151 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2152 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2153
2154 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2155 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2156 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2157
2158 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2159 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2160 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2161 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2162 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2163 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2164 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2165 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2166 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2167
2168 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2169 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2170 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2174 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2175 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2176 output from the Tcl engine.
2177 Intended as a machine interface.
2178 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2179 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2180 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2181 @end deffn
2182
2183 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2184 Specify or query the
2185 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2186 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2187 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2188 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2189 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2193 @section GDB Configuration
2194 @cindex GDB
2195 @cindex GDB configuration
2196 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2197 The ones listed here are static and global.
2198 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2199 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2200
2201 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2202 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2203 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2204 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2205 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2206 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2207 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2211 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2213 vFlash packet is received.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2219 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2220 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2221 for flash programming to work.
2222 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2223 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2227 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2228 by GDB memory read packets.
2229 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2230 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2234 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2235 packets report errors or not.
2236 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2237 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2238 @end deffn
2239
2240 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2241 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2242 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2243 @end deffn
2244
2245 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2246 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2247
2248 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2249 @end deffn
2250
2251 @anchor{eventpolling}
2252 @section Event Polling
2253
2254 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2255 where significant events can happen at any time.
2256 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2257 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2258 or to GDB.
2259
2260 Examples of such events include:
2261
2262 @itemize
2263 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2264 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2265 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2266 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2267 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2268 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2269 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2270 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2271 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2272 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2273 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2274 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2275 @end itemize
2276
2277 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2278 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2279 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2280 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2281 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2282
2283 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2284 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2285 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2286 to the various active targets.
2287 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2288 which is normally done in the background.
2289
2290 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2291 Poll the current target for its current state.
2292 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2293 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2294 specific information about the current state is printed.
2295 An optional parameter
2296 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2297
2298 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2299 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2300 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2301 @example
2302 > poll
2303 background polling: on
2304 target state: halted
2305 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2306 current mode: Supervisor
2307 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2308 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2309 >
2310 @end example
2311 @end deffn
2312
2313 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2314 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2315 @cindex config file, interface
2316 @cindex interface config file
2317
2318 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2319 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2320 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2321
2322 @quotation Note
2323 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2324 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2325 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2326 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2327 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2328 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2329 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2330 @end quotation
2331
2332 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2333 through commands in an interface configuration
2334 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2335 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2336
2337 @example
2338 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2339 @end example
2340
2341 These commands tell
2342 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2343 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2344
2345 @example
2346 # jlink interface
2347 adapter driver jlink
2348 @end example
2349
2350 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2351
2352
2353 @section Adapter Configuration
2354
2355 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2356 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2357 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2358
2359 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2360 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2361 target.
2362 @end deffn
2363
2364 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2365 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2366 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2367 @end deffn
2368 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2369 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2370 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2371 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2372 the hardware can support.
2373 @end deffn
2374
2375
2376
2377 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2378 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2379 @end deffn
2380
2381 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2382 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2383 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2384 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2385 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2386 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2387 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2388
2389 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @section Interface Drivers
2393
2394 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2395 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2396 available at run time.
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2399 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2400 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2401 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2402
2403 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2404 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2405 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2406 @end deffn
2407
2408 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2409 Displays status of RTCK option.
2410 Optionally sets that option first.
2411 @end deffn
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2415 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2416 This has one driver-specific command:
2417
2418 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2419 Logs some status
2420 @end deffn
2421 @end deffn
2422
2423 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2424 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2425 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2426 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2427 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2428 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2432 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2433
2434 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2435 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2436 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2437 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2438 @example
2439 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2440 @end example
2441 @end deffn
2442
2443 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2444 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2445 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2449 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2450 @end deffn
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2454 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2458 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2462 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2463 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2464
2465 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2466 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2467
2468 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2469 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2470
2471 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2472 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2473 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2474 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2475 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2476 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2477
2478 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2479 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2480 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2481 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2482 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2483
2484 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2485 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2486 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2487 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2488
2489 @itemize @minus
2490 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2491 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2493 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2494 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2495 switching data and direction as necessary
2496 @end itemize
2497
2498 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2499 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2502 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2503 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2504 @example
2505 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2506 @end example
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2510 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2511 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2512 during device selection.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2516 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2517 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2518 is connected to the host.
2519 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2520 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2521 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2522 @end deffn
2523
2524 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2525 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2526 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2527
2528 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2529 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2530 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2531 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2532 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2533
2534 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2538 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2539 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2543 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2544 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2545 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2546 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2547 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2548 and initially asserted reset signals.
2549 @end deffn
2550
2551 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2552 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2553 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2554 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2555 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2556 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2557 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2558 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2559 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2560 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2561 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2562
2563 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2564 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2565 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2566 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2567 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2568 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2569
2570 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2571 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2572 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2573 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2574 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2575 are always driven by the FTDI.
2576
2577 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2578 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2579 @var{name}.
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2583 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2584 @itemize @minus
2585 @item @option{0}, drive low
2586 @item @option{1}, drive high
2587 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2588 @end itemize
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2592 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2596 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2597
2598 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2599 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2600 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2601 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2604 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2605 @end itemize
2606 @end deffn
2607
2608 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2609 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2610
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2614 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2615 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2616 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2617
2618 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2619 @itemize @minus
2620 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2621 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2622 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2623 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2624 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2625 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2626 @end itemize
2627
2628 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2629 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2630 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2631 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2632 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2633 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2634 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2635 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2636
2637 FT232R
2638 @itemize @minus
2639 @item bit 7 - RI
2640 @item bit 6 - DCD
2641 @item bit 5 - DSR
2642 @item bit 4 - DTR
2643 @item bit 3 - CTS
2644 @item bit 2 - RTS
2645 @item bit 1 - RXD
2646 @item bit 0 - TXD
2647 @end itemize
2648
2649 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2650 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2653 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2654 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2655 @end deffn
2656
2657 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2658 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2659 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2660 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2664 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2665 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2669 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2673 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2677 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2681 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2685 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2689 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2693 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2694 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2695 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2696 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2697 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2698 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2699 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2700 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2701 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2707 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2708 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2709 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2710
2711 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2712 processors which are being simulated.
2713
2714 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2715 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2716 sockets instead of TCP.
2717 @end deffn
2718
2719 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2720 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2721 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2725 something like:
2726
2727 @example
2728 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2729 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2730 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2731 @end example
2732
2733 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2734 named mysocket:
2735
2736 @example
2737 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2738 remote_bitbang_port 0
2739 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2740 @end example
2741 @end deffn
2742
2743 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2744 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2745 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2746 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2747
2748 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2749 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2750 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2751 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2752 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2756 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2757 default values are used.
2758 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2759 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2760 @example
2761 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2762 @end example
2763 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2764 @example
2765 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2766 @end example
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2770 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2771 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2772 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2773 target board.
2774
2775 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2776 @example
2777 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2778 reset_config srst_only
2779 @end example
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2783 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2784 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2785 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2786 @end deffn
2787
2788 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2789 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2790 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2791 @end deffn
2792
2793 @end deffn
2794
2795 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2796 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2797 This has one driver-specific command:
2798
2799 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2800 Display either the address of the I/O port
2801 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2802 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2803 This is a write-once setting.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @end deffn
2806
2807 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2808 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2809 transports.
2810
2811 @quotation Compatibility Note
2812 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2813 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2814 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2815 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2816 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2817 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2818 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2819 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2820 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2821 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2822 @end quotation
2823
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2825 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2826 states.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2829 Display free device internal memory.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2832 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2833 command version.
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2836 Display the device configuration.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2839 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2840 power state.
2841 @end deffn
2842 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2843 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2846 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2847 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2848 IP configuration.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2851 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2852 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2855 Reset the current configuration.
2856 @end deffn
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2858 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2861 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2862 pairs.
2863
2864 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2865 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2866 @example
2867 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2868 @end example
2869 @end deffn
2870 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2871 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2872 pairs.
2873
2874 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2875 @example
2876 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2877 77a90000
2878 @end example
2879 @end deffn
2880 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2881 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2882 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2883 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2884 the serial number instead, if possible.
2885
2886 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2887 @end deffn
2888 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2889 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2890 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2891
2892 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2893 @end deffn
2894 @end deffn
2895
2896 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2897 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2898 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2899 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2900 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2901 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2902 configuration script.
2903
2904 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2905 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2906 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2907 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2908 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2909
2910 Known limitations:
2911 @itemize @bullet
2912 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2913 and 2.7 MHz.
2914 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2915 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2916 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2917 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2918 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2919 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2920 communications with the target.
2921 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2922 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2923 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2924 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2925 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2926 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2927 @end itemize
2928
2929 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2930 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2931 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2932 @end deffn
2933
2934 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2935 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2936 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2937 @end deffn
2938
2939 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2940 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2941 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2942 target as a side-effect.
2943 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2944 @end deffn
2945
2946 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2947 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2948 version, and target voltage.
2949 @end deffn
2950 @end deffn
2951
2952 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2953 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2954 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2955 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2956 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2957
2958 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2959 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2960 This is a write-once setting.
2961 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2962
2963 @itemize @minus
2964 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2965 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2966 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2967 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2968 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2969 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2970 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2971 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2972 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2973 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2974 some versions of
2975 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2976 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2977 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2978 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2979 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2980 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2981 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2982 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2983 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2984 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2985 @end itemize
2986 @end deffn
2987
2988 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2989 Display either the address of the I/O port
2990 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2991 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2992 This is a write-once setting.
2993
2994 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2995 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2996 you may encounter a problem.
2997 @end deffn
2998
2999 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3000 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3001 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3002 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3003 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3004 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3005
3006 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3007 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3008 @quotation Tip
3009 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3010 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3011 @example
3012 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3013 > adapter speed 500
3014 @end example
3015 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3016 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3017 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3018 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3019 large set of samples.
3020 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3021 @example
3022 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3023 @end example
3024 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3025 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3026
3027 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3028 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3029 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3030 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3031 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3032 be conservative.
3033 @end quotation
3034 @end deffn
3035
3036 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3037 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3038 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3042 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3043
3044 @example
3045 adapter driver parport
3046 parport_port 0x278
3047 parport_cable wiggler
3048 @end example
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3052 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3053 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3054 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3055 @end deffn
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3059 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3060 @end deffn
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3063 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3067 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3068
3069 @quotation Note
3070 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3071 which are not currently documented here.
3072 @end quotation
3073 @end deffn
3074
3075 @anchor{hla_interface}
3076 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3077 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3078 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3079 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3080
3081 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3082 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3083 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3084 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3085 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3086 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3089 Currently Not Supported.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3093 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3097 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3101 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3102 @end deffn
3103
3104 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3105 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3106 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3107 @end deffn
3108 @end deffn
3109
3110 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3111 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3112 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3113 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3114 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3115
3116 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3117 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3118 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3119 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3120
3121 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3122 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3123
3124 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3125 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3129 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3130 @end deffn
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3134 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3135 @end deffn
3136
3137 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3138 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3142 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3143 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3144 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3145 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3146
3147 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3148 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3149 XDS110 found will be used.
3150 @end deffn
3151
3152 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3153 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3154 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3155 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3156 @end deffn
3157
3158 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3159 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3160 version).
3161 @end deffn
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3165 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3166 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3167 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3168 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3169
3170 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3171
3172 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3173 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3174
3175 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3176 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3177
3178 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3179
3180 @end deffn
3181 @end deffn
3182
3183 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3184 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3185 @end deffn
3186
3187 @quotation Note
3188 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3189 which are not currently documented here.
3190 @end quotation
3191
3192 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3193 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3194 No arguments: print status.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3198 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3199 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3200
3201 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3202 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3203 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3204 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3205 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3206 configuration on exit.
3207
3208 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3209 pinout.
3210
3211 @end deffn
3212
3213 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3214 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3215 of the one which is most popular.
3216
3217 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3218
3219 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3220 pinout.
3221
3222 @end deffn
3223
3224
3225 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3226 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3227 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3228
3229 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3230 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3231 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3232
3233 @itemize @minus
3234 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3235 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3236 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3237 @end itemize
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3241 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3242 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3243 @end deffn
3244 @end deffn
3245
3246
3247 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3248 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3249 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3250 DPI server interface.
3251
3252 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3253 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3254 @end deffn
3255
3256 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3257 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3258 @end deffn
3259 @end deffn
3260
3261
3262 @section Transport Configuration
3263 @cindex Transport
3264 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3265 and the debug adapter you are using,
3266 several transports may be available to
3267 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3268 @deffn Command {transport list}
3269 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3270 version of OpenOCD.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3274 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3275
3276 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3277 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3278 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3279 adapter's driver).
3280
3281 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3282 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3283 supported by the debug adapter.
3284
3285 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3286 transport, if any.
3287 @end deffn
3288
3289 @subsection JTAG Transport
3290 @cindex JTAG
3291 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3292 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3293 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3294 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3295 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3296 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3297
3298 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3299 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3300 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3301 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3302 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3303
3304 @subsection SWD Transport
3305 @cindex SWD
3306 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3307 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3308 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3309 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3310 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3311 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3312 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3313
3314 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3315 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3316 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3317 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3318 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3319
3320 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3321 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3322 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3323 expected to change.
3324 @end deffn
3325 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3326 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3327 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3328 No parameters: displays current settings.
3329 @end deffn
3330
3331 @subsection SPI Transport
3332 @cindex SPI
3333 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3334 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3335 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3336 solution for flash programming.
3337
3338 @anchor{swimtransport}
3339 @subsection SWIM Transport
3340 @cindex SWIM
3341 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3342 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3343 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3344 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3345
3346 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3347
3348 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3349
3350 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3351 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3352 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3353 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3354 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3355
3356 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3357 @section JTAG Speed
3358 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3359 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3360 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3361 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3362 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3363 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3364 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3365 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3366 power management software that may be active.
3367
3368 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3369 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3370 target event handler.
3371 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3372 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3373 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3374 sets up those clocks).
3375 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3376 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3377 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3378 in the target config file.
3379 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3380 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3381 config file instead.
3382 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3383 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3384 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3385
3386 @example
3387 jtag_rclk 3000
3388 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3389 @end example
3390
3391 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3392 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3393 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3394 may not be the fastest solution.
3395
3396 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3397 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3398 which support adaptive clocking.
3399
3400 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3401 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3402 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3403 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3404 than the speed specified.
3405
3406 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3407 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3408 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3409 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3410
3411 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3412 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3413 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3414 JTAG clocking after setup.
3415 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3416 If the interface device can not
3417 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3418 @end deffn
3419
3420 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3421 @cindex adaptive clocking
3422 @cindex RTCK
3423 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3424 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3425 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3426 @example
3427 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3428 jtag_rclk 3000
3429 @end example
3430 @end defun
3431
3432 @node Reset Configuration
3433 @chapter Reset Configuration
3434 @cindex Reset Configuration
3435
3436 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3437 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3438 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3439 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3440 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3441 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3442 Please see the various board files for examples.
3443
3444 @quotation Note
3445 To maintainers and integrators:
3446 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3447 Normally the board configuration file
3448 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3449 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3450
3451 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3452 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3453 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3454 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3455 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3456 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3457 @end quotation
3458
3459 @section Types of Reset
3460
3461 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3462 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3463 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3464
3465 @itemize @bullet
3466 @item
3467 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3468 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3469 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3470 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3471 @item
3472 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3473 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3474 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3475 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3476 @item
3477 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3478 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3479 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3480 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3481 @item
3482 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3483 several other types of reset.
3484 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3485 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3486 There may be individual module resets.
3487 @end itemize
3488
3489 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3490 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3491 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3492 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3493 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3494 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3495 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3496 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3497 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3498
3499 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3500 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3501
3502 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3503 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3504 common issues are:
3505
3506 @itemize @bullet
3507
3508 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3509 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3510 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3511 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3512 when either of those signals is not connected.
3513 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3514 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3515 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3516 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3517
3518 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3519 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3520 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3521 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3522
3523 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3524 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3525 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3526 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3527 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3528 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3529 hardware debouncing.
3530 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3531 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3532
3533 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3534 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3535 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3536 to use push/pull output drivers.
3537 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3538 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3539 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3540 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3541
3542 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3543 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3544 issues (not limited to errata).
3545 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3546 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3547 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3548 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3549 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3550 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3551 @end itemize
3552
3553 There can also be other issues.
3554 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3555 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3556 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3557 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3558 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3559 Agreement (NDA).
3560
3561 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3562 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3563 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3564
3565 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3566 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3567
3568 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3569
3570 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3571 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3572 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3573 allowing it to be deasserted.
3574 @end deffn
3575
3576 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3577 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3578 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3579 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3580 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3581 @end deffn
3582
3583 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3584 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3585 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3586 allowing it to be deasserted.
3587 @end deffn
3588
3589 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3590 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3591 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3592 @end deffn
3593
3594 @anchor{reset_config}
3595 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3596 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3597 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3598 configuration scripts.
3599
3600 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3601 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3602 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3603 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3604 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3605 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3606 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3607 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3608
3609 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3610 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3611 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3612 -- may be specified at a time.
3613 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3614 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3615 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3616 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3617 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3618
3619 @itemize
3620 @item
3621 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3622 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3623 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3624 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3625 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3626
3627 @quotation Tip
3628 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3629 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3630 @end quotation
3631
3632 @item
3633 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3634 signal implementations.
3635 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3636 indicating everything behaves normally.
3637 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3638 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3639 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3640 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3641 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3642 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3643 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3644
3645 @item
3646 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3647 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3648 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3649 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3650 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3651 while SRST is asserted.
3652 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3653 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3654
3655 @item
3656 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3657 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3658 is required to use this option.
3659 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3660 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3661 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3662 be asserted before any target connection.
3663 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3664 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3665 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3666 @end itemize
3667
3668 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3669 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3670 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3671 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3672 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3673
3674 @itemize
3675 @item
3676 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3677 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3678 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3679 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3680
3681 @item
3682 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3683 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3684 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3685 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3686 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3687 @end itemize
3688 @end deffn
3689
3690 @section Custom Reset Handling
3691 @cindex events
3692
3693 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3694 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3695 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3696 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3697 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3698 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3699
3700 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3701 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3702 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3703 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3704 want to reset everything at once.
3705
3706 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3707 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3708 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3709 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3710 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3711 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3712 needs special attention.
3713
3714 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3715 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3716 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3717 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3718 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3719 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3720 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3721 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3722 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3723
3724 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3725 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3726 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3727 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3728 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3729
3730 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3731 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3732 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3733 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3734 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3735 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3736 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3737 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3738 or potentially some other value.
3739
3740 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3741 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3742 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3743 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3744 (or their associated targets)
3745 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3746
3747 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3748 they return.
3749 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3750 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3751 @end deffn
3752
3753 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3754 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3755 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3756 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3757 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3758 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3759 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3760 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3761 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3762 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3763 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3764 @end deffn
3765
3766 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3767 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3768 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3769 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3770 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3771 @end deffn
3772
3773
3774 @node TAP Declaration
3775 @chapter TAP Declaration
3776 @cindex TAP declaration
3777 @cindex TAP configuration
3778
3779 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3780 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3781
3782 @itemize @bullet
3783 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3784 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3785 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3786 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3787 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3788 start running that code.
3789 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3790 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3791 and missing connections.
3792 @end itemize
3793
3794 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3795 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3796 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3797 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3798 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3799
3800 @section Scan Chains
3801 @cindex scan chain
3802
3803 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3804 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3805 They also need to be added to
3806 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3807 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3808 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3809 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3810 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3811 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3812 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3813 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3814
3815 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3816 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3817 command, presented in the next chapter.
3818 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3819 debugging targets.)
3820 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3821
3822 @verbatim
3823 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3824 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3825 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3826 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3827 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3828 @end verbatim
3829
3830 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3831 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3832 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3833 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3834 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3835 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3836 until they are told to do so.
3837
3838 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3839 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3840 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3841 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3842
3843 @example
3844 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3845 @end example
3846
3847 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3848 by a given chip.
3849 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3850 and so forth.
3851 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3852 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3853 both inside a single chip and between them.
3854 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3855
3856 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3857 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3858 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3859 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3860 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3861 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3862 includes commands something like this:
3863
3864 @example
3865 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3866 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3867 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3868 @end example
3869
3870 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3871 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3872 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3873
3874 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3875 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3876 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3877 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3878 @example
3879 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3880 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3881 @}
3882 @end example
3883 @end deffn
3884
3885 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3886 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3887 and their status.
3888 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3889 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3890 but systems with a JTAG router can
3891 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3892 @end deffn
3893
3894 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3895 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3896
3897 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3898 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3899
3900 @section TAP Names
3901 @cindex dotted name
3902
3903 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3904 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3905 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3906 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3907 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3908 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3909 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3910 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3911
3912 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3913 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3914 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3915
3916 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3917
3918 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3919 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3920 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3921 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3922
3923 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3924 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3925 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3926 overridable.
3927
3928 @cindex TAP naming convention
3929 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3930 and should follow this convention:
3931
3932 @itemize @bullet
3933 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3934 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3935 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3936 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3937 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3938 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3939 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3940 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3941 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3942 with a single TAP;
3943 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3944 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3945 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3946 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3947 @end itemize
3948
3949 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3950
3951 @itemize @bullet
3952 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3953 @*The length in bits of the
3954 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3955 @end itemize
3956
3957 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3958
3959 @itemize @bullet
3960 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3961 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3962 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3963 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3964 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3965 (the TAP is linked in).
3966 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3967 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3968 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3969 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3970 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3971 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3972 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3973 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3974 values that were found but not included in the list.
3975
3976 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3977 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3978 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3979 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3980 hardware to find these values.
3981 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3982 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3983 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3984 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3985 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3986 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3987 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3988 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3989 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3990 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3991 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3992 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3993 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3994 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3995 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3996 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3997 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3998 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3999 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4000 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4001 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4002 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4003 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4004 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4005 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4006 @end itemize
4007 @end deffn
4008
4009 @section Other TAP commands
4010
4011 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4012 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4013 @end deffn
4014
4015 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4016 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4017 At this writing this TAP attribute
4018 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4019 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4020 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4021 See the next section for information about the available events.
4022
4023 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4024 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4025 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4026 @end deffn
4027
4028 @section TAP Events
4029 @cindex events
4030 @cindex TAP events
4031
4032 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4033 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4034 The other applies to debugger targets,
4035 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4036
4037 The TAP events currently defined are:
4038
4039 @itemize @bullet
4040 @item @b{post-reset}
4041 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4042 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4043 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4044 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4045 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4046
4047 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4048 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4049 of any particular target.
4050 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4051 @item @b{setup}
4052 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4053 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4054 @item @b{tap-disable}
4055 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4056 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4057 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4058 @item @b{tap-enable}
4059 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4060 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4061 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4062 @end itemize
4063
4064 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4065 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4066 contents to be accurate), you might:
4067
4068 @example
4069 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4070 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4071 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4072 @}
4073 @end example
4074
4075
4076 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4077 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4078 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4079 @cindex jrc
4080
4081 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4082 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4083 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4084 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4085 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4086
4087 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4088 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4089 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4090 be visible.
4091 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4092 ignores, such as:
4093
4094 @itemize
4095 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4096 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4097 TAPs receive new instructions.
4098 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4099 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4100 @end itemize
4101
4102 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4103 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4104 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4105 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4106
4107 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4108 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4109
4110 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4111 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4112 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4113 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4114 should define TAP event handlers using
4115 code that looks something like this:
4116
4117 @example
4118 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4119 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4120 @}
4121 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4122 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4123 @}
4124 @end example
4125
4126 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4127
4128 @example
4129 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4130 @end example
4131
4132 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4133 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4134 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4135 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4136
4137 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4138 If necessary, disables the tap
4139 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4140 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4141 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4142 and "0" if it is disabled.
4143 @end deffn
4144
4145 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4146 If necessary, enables the tap
4147 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4148 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4149 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4150 and "0" if it is disabled.
4151 @end deffn
4152
4153 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4154 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4155 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4156 and "0" if it is disabled.
4157
4158 @quotation Note
4159 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4160 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4161 @end quotation
4162 @end deffn
4163
4164 @anchor{autoprobing}
4165 @section Autoprobing
4166 @cindex autoprobe
4167 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4168
4169 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4170 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4171 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4172 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4173
4174 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4175 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4176 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4177 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4178 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4179 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4180 right when they come out of reset).
4181
4182 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4183
4184 @example
4185 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4186 reset_config trst_and_srst
4187 jtag_rclk 8
4188 @end example
4189
4190 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4191 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4192
4193 @enumerate
4194 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4195 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4196 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4197 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4198 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4199 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4200 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4201 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4202 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4203 that is discovered.
4204 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4205 register, it will report it.
4206 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4207 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4208 @end enumerate
4209
4210 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4211 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4212 that's a bit more complex:
4213
4214 @example
4215 clock speed 8 kHz
4216 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4217 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4218 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4219 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4220 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4221 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4222 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4223 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4224 @end example
4225
4226 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4227 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4228 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4229 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4230 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4231 and so forth.
4232
4233 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4234 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4235 @cindex DAP declaration
4236
4237 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4238 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4239 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4240 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4241 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4242
4243 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4244
4245 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4246 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4247 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4248 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4249 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4250
4251 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4252
4253 @itemize @bullet
4254 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4255 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4256 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4257 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4258 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4259 @end itemize
4260 @end deffn
4261
4262 @deffn Command {dap names}
4263 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4264 for TCL scripting.
4265 @end deffn
4266
4267 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4268 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4269 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @deffn Command {dap init}
4273 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4274 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4275 initialization, too.
4276 @end deffn
4277
4278 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4279
4280 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4281 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4282 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4286 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4290 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4291 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4292 or set a new value @var{value}.
4293 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4297 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4298 @end deffn
4299
4300 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4301 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4302 value @var{value}.
4303
4304 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4305 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4306 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4307
4308 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4309 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4310 @end deffn
4311
4312 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4313 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4314 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4318 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4319 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4320 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4321 @end deffn
4322
4323 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4324 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4325
4326 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4327 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4328 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4329 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4330 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4331 for details.
4332
4333 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4334 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4335 the pattern:
4336 @example
4337 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4338 @end example
4339
4340 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4341 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4342 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4343 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4344 @example
4345 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4346 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4347 @end example
4348
4349 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4350 @example
4351 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4352 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4353 @end example
4354
4355 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4356 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4357
4358 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4359 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4360 example with a proper dap name:
4361 @example
4362 xxx.dap apcsw default
4363 @end example
4364 @end deffn
4365
4366 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4367 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4368 Disabled by default
4369 @end deffn
4370
4371
4372 @node CPU Configuration
4373 @chapter CPU Configuration
4374 @cindex GDB target
4375
4376 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4377 You can also access these targets without GDB
4378 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4379 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4380 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4381 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4382
4383 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4384 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4385
4386 @section Target List
4387 @cindex target, current
4388 @cindex target, list
4389
4390 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4391 where each member has a name.
4392 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4393 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4394 (plural!) command.
4395 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4396 look like with more than one:
4397 @verbatim
4398 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4399 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4400 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4401 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4402 @end verbatim
4403
4404 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4405 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4406 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4407 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4408 space seen by that current target.
4409 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4410 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4411 are examples; and there are many more.
4412
4413 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4414
4415 @deffn Command {target current}
4416 Returns the name of the current target.
4417 @end deffn
4418
4419 @deffn Command {target names}
4420 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4421 @example
4422 foreach t [target names] @{
4423 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4424 @}
4425 @end example
4426 @end deffn
4427
4428 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4429 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4430
4431 @deffn Command targets [name]
4432 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4433 command names are singular.}
4434
4435 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4436 targets in a user friendly form.
4437
4438 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4439 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4440 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 @section Target CPU Types
4444 @cindex target type
4445 @cindex CPU type
4446
4447 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4448 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4449 when calling @command{target create}.
4450 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4451 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4452 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4453 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4454 what core-specific commands may be available
4455 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4456 and more.
4457
4458 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4459 since there's a command to list them.
4460
4461 @anchor{targettypes}
4462 @deffn Command {target types}
4463 Lists all supported target types.
4464 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4465
4466 @itemize @bullet
4467 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4468 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4469 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4470 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4471 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4472 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4473 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4474 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4475 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4476 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4477 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4478 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4479 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4480 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4481 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4482 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4483 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4484 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4485 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4486 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4487 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4488 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4489 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4490 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4491 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4492 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4493 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4494 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4495 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4496 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4497 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4498 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4499 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4500 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4501 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4502 @itemize @minus
4503 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4504 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4505 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4506 @end itemize
4507 And two debug interfaces cores:
4508 @itemize @minus
4509 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4510 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4511 @end itemize
4512 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4513 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4514 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4515 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4516 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4517 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4518 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4519 @end itemize
4520 @end deffn
4521
4522 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4523 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4524 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4525 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4526 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4527 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4528 reflect design generations;
4529 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4530 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4531
4532 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4533 @section Target Configuration
4534
4535 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4536 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4537 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4538 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4539 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4540
4541 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4542 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4543 optional parts.
4544 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4545 command, created as part of target creation.
4546
4547 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4548 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4549 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4550 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4551 to be much more board-specific.
4552 The key steps you use might look something like this
4553
4554 @example
4555 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4556 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4557 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4558 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4559 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4560 @end example
4561
4562 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4563 on-chip SRAM.
4564 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4565 writes to target memory;
4566 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4567 GDB memory checksumming;
4568 and more.
4569
4570 @quotation Warning
4571 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4572 inaccessible when application code
4573 (such as an operating system)
4574 enables or disables the MMU.
4575 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4576 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4577 easy access to other addresses needed.
4578 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4579 @end quotation
4580
4581 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4582 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4583 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4584 controllers.
4585 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4586 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4587 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4588
4589 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4590 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4591 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4592 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4593 purposes including additional configuration.
4594
4595 @itemize @bullet
4596 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4597 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4598 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4599 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4600
4601 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4602 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4603 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4604 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4605 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4606 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4607 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4608
4609 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4610 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4611 @end itemize
4612 @end deffn
4613
4614 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4615 The options accepted by this command may also be
4616 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4617 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4618 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4619
4620 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4621 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4622 and changing its endianness.
4623
4624 @itemize @bullet
4625
4626 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4627 used to access this target.
4628
4629 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4630 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4631 create and manage DAP instances.
4632
4633 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4634 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4635
4636 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4637 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4638 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4639 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4640 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4641 same event name assigns only one handler.
4642
4643 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4644 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4645
4646 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4647 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4648 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4649 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4650 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4651 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4652 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4653
4654 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4655 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4656 or virtual address is being used.
4657
4658 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4659 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4660
4661 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4662 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4663 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4664 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4665 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4666
4667 @anchor{rtostype}
4668 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4669 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4670 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4671 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4672 @option{RIOT}
4673 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4674
4675 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4676 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4677 access the target for debugging.
4678
4679 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4680 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4681 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4682 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4683
4684 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4685 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4686 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4687 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4688 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4689
4690 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4691 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4692 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4693 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4694 command @command{gdb_port}.
4695 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4696
4697 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4698 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4699 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4700 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4701 @end itemize
4702 @end deffn
4703
4704 @section Other $target_name Commands
4705 @cindex object command
4706
4707 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4708 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4709
4710 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4711 Once a button is created a button
4712 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4713 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4714 configure it like this:
4715
4716 @example
4717 # Create
4718 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4719 # Modify
4720 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4721 # Query
4722 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4723 # Report
4724 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4725 @end example
4726
4727 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4728 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4729
4730 @example
4731 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4732 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4733 @end example
4734
4735 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4736
4737 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4738 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4739 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4740 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4741 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4742 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4743 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4744 They are not otherwise documented here.
4745 @end deffn
4746
4747 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4748 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4749 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4750 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4751 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4752 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4753 the target side uses raw memory.
4754
4755 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4756 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4757 The script orientation comes from working with data
4758 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4759 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4760 and neither store nor return those values.
4761
4762 @itemize
4763 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4764 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4765 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4766 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4767 @end itemize
4768 @end deffn
4769
4770 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4771 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4772 @command{$target_name configure}
4773 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4774 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4775 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4776 There are a few special cases:
4777
4778 @itemize @bullet
4779 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4780 event named @var{event_name}.
4781 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4782 two parameters.
4783 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4784 This is a special case because this is set using
4785 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4786 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4787 @end itemize
4788
4789 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4790 all the targets you might use something like this:
4791
4792 @example
4793 foreach name [target names] @{
4794 set y [$name cget -endian]
4795 set z [$name cget -type]
4796 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4797 $x $name $y $z]
4798 @}
4799 @end example
4800 @end deffn
4801
4802 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4803 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4804 Displays the current target state:
4805 @code{debug-running},
4806 @code{halted},
4807 @code{reset},
4808 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4809 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4810 @end deffn
4811
4812 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4813 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4814 currently associated with this target.
4815 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4816 @end deffn
4817
4818 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4819 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4820 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4821 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4822 @end deffn
4823
4824 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4825 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4826 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4827 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4828 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4829 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4830 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4831 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4832 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4833 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4834 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4835 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4836 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4837 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4838 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4839 @end deffn
4840
4841 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4842 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4843 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4844 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4845 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4846 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4847 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4848 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4849 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4850 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4851 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4852 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4853 @end deffn
4854
4855 @anchor{targetevents}
4856 @section Target Events
4857 @cindex target events
4858 @cindex events
4859 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4860 For example:
4861 @itemize @bullet
4862 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4863 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4864 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4865 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4866 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4867 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4868 to set up system clocks or
4869 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4870 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4871 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4872 @end itemize
4873
4874 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4875 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4876 @command{target create ... -event}.
4877
4878 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4879 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4880 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4881
4882 @example
4883 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4884 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4885 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4886 @}
4887 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4888 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4889 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4890 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4891 @}
4892 @end example
4893
4894 The following target events are defined:
4895
4896 @itemize @bullet
4897 @item @b{debug-halted}
4898 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4899 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4900 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4901 @item @b{early-halted}
4902 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4903 @item @b{examine-start}
4904 @* Before target examine is called.
4905 @item @b{examine-end}
4906 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4907 @item @b{examine-fail}
4908 @* After target examine fails.
4909 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4910 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4911 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4912 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4913 connect GDB to running target.
4914 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4915 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4916 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4917 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4918 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4919 is in RAM or read only memory.
4920 Default is @code{halt}
4921 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4922 @* When GDB disconnects
4923 @item @b{gdb-end}
4924 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4925 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4926 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4927 @code{reset init})
4928 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4929 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4930 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4931 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4932 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4933 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4934 @item @b{gdb-start}
4935 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4936 @item @b{halted}
4937 @* The target has halted
4938 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4939 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4940 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4941 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4942 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4943 @item @b{reset-assert}
4944 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4945 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4946 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4947 it instead of asserting SRST.
4948 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4949 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4950 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4951 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4952 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4953 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4954 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4955 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4956 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4957 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4958 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4959 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4960 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4961 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4962 released on the scan chain.
4963 @item @b{reset-end}
4964 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4965 @item @b{reset-init}
4966 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4967 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4968
4969 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4970 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4971 multiplexing, and so on.
4972 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4973 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4974 @item @b{reset-start}
4975 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4976 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4977
4978 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4979 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4980 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4981 @item @b{resume-start}
4982 @* Before any target is resumed
4983 @item @b{resume-end}
4984 @* After all targets have resumed
4985 @item @b{resumed}
4986 @* Target has resumed
4987 @item @b{step-start}
4988 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4989 @item @b{step-end}
4990 @* After single-step has completed
4991 @item @b{trace-config}
4992 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4993 @end itemize
4994
4995 @node Flash Commands
4996 @chapter Flash Commands
4997
4998 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4999 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5000 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5001 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5002 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5003 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5004 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5005 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5006 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5007
5008 Flash Steps:
5009 @enumerate
5010 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5011 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5012 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5013 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5014 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5015 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5016 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5017 @item GDB Flashing
5018 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5019 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5020 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5021 @end enumerate
5022
5023 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5024 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5025 so that it can't boot.
5026 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5027 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5028
5029 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5030 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5031 @cindex flash configuration
5032
5033 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5034 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5035 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5036 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5037 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5038 see the driver-specific documentation.
5039
5040 @itemize @bullet
5041 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5042 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5043 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5044 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5045 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5046 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5047 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5048 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5049 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5050 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5051 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5052 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5053 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5054 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5055 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5056 commands to the flash controller.
5057 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5058 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5059 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5060 for more information.
5061 @end itemize
5062 @quotation Note
5063 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5064 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5065 @end quotation
5066 @end deffn
5067
5068 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5069 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5070 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5071 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5072 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5073 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5074 @end deffn
5075
5076 @deffn Command {flash list}
5077 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5078 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5079 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5080 @end deffn
5081
5082 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5083 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5084 depends on the flash type.
5085 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5086 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5087 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5088 but most don't bother.
5089 @end deffn
5090
5091 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5092
5093 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5094 begins.
5095
5096 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5097 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5098 until the programming session is finished.
5099
5100 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5101 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5102
5103 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5104
5105 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5106 @cindex flash erasing
5107 @cindex flash reading
5108 @cindex flash writing
5109 @cindex flash programming
5110 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5111
5112 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5113 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5114 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5115 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5116 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5117
5118 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5119 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5120 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5121 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5122 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5123
5124 @quotation Note
5125 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5126 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5127 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5128 back to a flash bank.
5129 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5130 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5131 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5132 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5133 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5134 @end quotation
5135
5136 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5137 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5138 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5139 disabled first.
5140 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5141 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5142 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5143
5144 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5145 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5146 up to and including @var{last}.
5147 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5148 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5149 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5150 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5151 @end deffn
5152
5153 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5154 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5155 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5156 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5157 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5158 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5159 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5160 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5161 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5162 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5163 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5164 before erase starts.
5165 @end deffn
5166
5167 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5168 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5169 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5170 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5171 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5172 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5173 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5174 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5175 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5176 before issuing this command.
5177 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5178 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5179 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5180 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5181 @end deffn
5182 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5183
5184 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5185 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5186 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5187 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5188 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5189 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5190 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5191 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5192 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5193 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5194 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5195 @end deffn
5196
5197 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5198 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5199 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5200 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5201 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5202 @end deffn
5203
5204 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5205 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5206 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5207 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5208 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5209 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5210 @end deffn
5211
5212 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5213 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5214 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5215 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5216 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5217 @end deffn
5218
5219 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5220 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5221 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5222 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5223 to the base address for each section in the image.
5224 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5225 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5226 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5227 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5228 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5229 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5230 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5231 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5232 each image section.
5233
5234 @quotation Warning
5235 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5236 data you want to preserve.
5237 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5238 sections might be erased with no notice.
5239 @itemize
5240 @item
5241 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5242 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5243 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5244 @item
5245 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5246 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5247 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5248 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5249 @end itemize
5250 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5251 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5252 @end quotation
5253
5254 @end deffn
5255
5256 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5257 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5258 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5259 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5260 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5261 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5262 ordinary memory reads.
5263 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5264 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5265 check for successful programming.
5266 @end deffn
5267
5268 @section Other Flash commands
5269 @cindex flash protection
5270
5271 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5272 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5273 and display that status.
5274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5275 @end deffn
5276
5277 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5278 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5279 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5280
5281 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5282 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5283 and possibly stale information.
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @anchor{flashprotect}
5287 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5288 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5289 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5290 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5291 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5292 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5293 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5294 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5295 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5296 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5300 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5301 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5302 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5303 @end deffn
5304
5305 @anchor{program}
5306 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5307 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5308 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5309 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5310 @end deffn
5311
5312 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5313 @section Flash Driver List
5314 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5315 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5316 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5317
5318 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5319 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5320 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5321
5322 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5323
5324 @itemize
5325 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5326 @end itemize
5327
5328 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5329 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5330 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5331 @example
5332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5333 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5334 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5335 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5336 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5337 @end example
5338 @end deffn
5339
5340 @subsection External Flash
5341
5342 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5343 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5344 @cindex CFI
5345 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5346 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5347 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5348 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5349 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5350 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5351 configure a bus and its timings), or
5352 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5353 on the flash chip.
5354 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5355 speed up operation.
5356
5357 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5358
5359 @itemize
5360 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5361 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5362 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5363 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5364 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5365 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5366 @end itemize
5367
5368 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5369 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5370
5371 @example
5372 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5373 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5374 @end example
5375
5376 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5377 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5378 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5379
5380 @example
5381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5382 @end example
5383
5384 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5385 @end deffn
5386
5387 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5388 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5389 @cindex SPI
5390 @cindex jtagspi
5391 @cindex bscan_spi
5392 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5393 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5394 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5395 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5396 accessed through JTAG.
5397
5398 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5399 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5400 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5401 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5402 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5403 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5404
5405 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5406 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5407 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5408 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5409 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5410 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5411 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5412 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5413
5414 @itemize
5415 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5416 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5417 @var{USER1} instruction.
5418 @end itemize
5419
5420 @example
5421 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5422 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5423 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5424 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5425 @end example
5426 @end deffn
5427
5428 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5429 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5430 @cindex xcf
5431 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5432 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5433 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5434 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5435 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5436
5437 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5438 command accepts additional parameters:
5439 @itemize
5440 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5441 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5442 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5443 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5444 in master mode.
5445 @end itemize
5446 @example
5447 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5448 @end example
5449 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5450 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5451 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5452 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5453 dedicated sector.
5454 @end deffn
5455
5456 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5457 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5458 button.
5459 @example
5460 xcf configure 0
5461 @end example
5462 @end deffn
5463
5464 Additional driver notes:
5465 @itemize
5466 @item Only single revision supported.
5467 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5468 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5469 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5470 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5471 @end itemize
5472 @end deffn
5473
5474 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5475 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5476 @cindex SPIFI
5477 @cindex lpcspifi
5478 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5479 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5480 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5481
5482 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5483 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5484 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5485 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5486 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5487
5488 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5489 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5490 are configured by the driver.
5491
5492 @example
5493 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5494 @end example
5495
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5499 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5500 @cindex SMI
5501 @cindex stmsmi
5502 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5503 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5504 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5505 SPI flash devices.
5506 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5507 flash devices can be connected.
5508
5509 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5510 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5511 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5512 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5513 the flash content.
5514
5515 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5516 to identify the memory bank.
5517 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5518 flash size, are detected automatically.
5519
5520 @example
5521 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5522 @end example
5523
5524 @end deffn
5525
5526 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5527 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5528 @cindex QuadSPI
5529 @cindex OctoSPI
5530 @cindex stmqspi
5531 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5532 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5533 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5534 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5535 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5536 mode is not.
5537
5538 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5539 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5540 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5541 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5542
5543 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5544 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5545 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5546
5547 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5548 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5549 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5550 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5551 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5552 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5553
5554 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5555 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5556 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5557 should be avoided.
5558
5559 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5560 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5561 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5562 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5563 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5564 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5565
5566 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5567 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5568 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5569 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5570 persist across openocd invocations.
5571
5572 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5573 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5574 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5575 required (see 'set' command).
5576
5577 @example
5578 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5579 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5580 @end example
5581
5582 There are three specific commands
5583 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5584 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5585 chip specific write protection engaged.
5586 @end deffn
5587
5588 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5589 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5590 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5591 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5592 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5593 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5594
5595 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5596 which don't support an id command.
5597
5598 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5599 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5603 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5604 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5605 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5606 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5607
5608 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5609 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5610 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5611 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5612
5613 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5614
5615 To check basic communication settings, issue
5616 @example
5617 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05; stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5618 @end example
5619 for single flash mode or
5620 @example
5621 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05; stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5622 @end example
5623 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5624
5625 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5626 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5627 need a dummy address, e.g.
5628 @example
5629 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5630 @end example
5631 should return the status register contents.
5632
5633 @end deffn
5634
5635 @end deffn
5636
5637 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5638 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5639 Microcontroller platform.
5640
5641 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5642 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5643
5644 @example
5645 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5646 @end example
5647
5648 @end deffn
5649
5650 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5651 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5652 @cindex ath79
5653 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5654 chip selects.
5655 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5656 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5657 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5658 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5659 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5660 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5661
5662 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5663 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5664 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5665 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5666 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5667 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5668 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5669 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5670 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5671 with the default CS0.
5672 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5673 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5674 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5675
5676 @example
5677 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5678
5679 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5680 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5681 # banks.
5682 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5683 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5684 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5685 @end example
5686
5687 @end deffn
5688
5689 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5690 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5691 @cindex fespi
5692
5693 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5694
5695 @example
5696 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5697 @end example
5698 @end deffn
5699
5700 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5701
5702 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5703 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5704 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5705 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5706 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5707 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5708
5709 @example
5710 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5711 @end example
5712 @end deffn
5713
5714 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5715 @cindex ambiqmicro
5716 @cindex apollo
5717 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5718 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5719 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5720 with the target using SWD.
5721
5722 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5723 the device class of the MCU.
5724 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5725 to set up the flash banks.
5726 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5727 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5728
5729 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5730 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5731 and the second bank starts after the first.
5732
5733 @example
5734 # Flash bank 0
5735 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5736 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5738 $_TARGETNAME
5739 @end example
5740
5741 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5742 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5743 are available to the user.
5744
5745 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5746
5747 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5748 Erase entire bank.
5749 @end deffn
5750 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5751 Erase device pages.
5752 @end deffn
5753 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5754 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5755 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5756 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5757 the flash.
5758 @end deffn
5759 @end deffn
5760
5761 @anchor{at91samd}
5762 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5763 @cindex at91samd
5764 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5765 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5766
5767 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5768
5769 The devices have one flash bank:
5770
5771 @example
5772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5773 @end example
5774
5775 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5776 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5777 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5778 processor to be halted.
5779 @end deffn
5780
5781 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5782 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5783 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5784 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5785 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5786 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5787
5788 @example
5789 at91samd set-security enable
5790 @end example
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5794 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5795 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5796 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5797 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5798 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5799 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5800 in order to disable this feature.
5801
5802 @example
5803 at91samd eeprom
5804 at91samd eeprom 1024
5805 @end example
5806 @end deffn
5807
5808 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5809 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5810 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5811 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5812 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5813 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5814
5815 @example
5816 at91samd bootloader
5817 at91samd bootloader 16384
5818 @end example
5819 @end deffn
5820
5821 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5822 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5823 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5824 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5825 @end deffn
5826
5827 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5828 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5829 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5830 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5831 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5832 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5833 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5834 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5835
5836 @example
5837 # Read user row
5838 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5839 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5840 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5841 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5842 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5843 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5844 @end example
5845 @end deffn
5846
5847 @end deffn
5848
5849 @anchor{at91sam3}
5850 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5851 @cindex at91sam3
5852 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5853 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5854 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5855 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5856 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5857 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5858 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5859 chips are confirmed.}
5860
5861 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5862 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5863 the following fixed locations:
5864
5865 @example
5866 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5868 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5869 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5870 @end example
5871
5872 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5873 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5874 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5875
5876 @itemize
5877 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5878 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5879 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5880 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5881 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5882 @end itemize
5883
5884 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5885
5886 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5887 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5888 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5889 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5890 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5891 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5892 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5893
5894 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5895 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5896 @end deffn
5897
5898 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5899 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5900 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5901 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5902 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5903 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5904 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5905 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5906 @end deffn
5907
5908 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5909 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5910 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5911 @end deffn
5912 @end deffn
5913
5914 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5915 @cindex at91sam4
5916 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5917 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5918 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5919 @end deffn
5920
5921 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5922 @cindex at91sam4l
5923 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5924 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5925 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5926
5927 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5928 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5929 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5930 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5931 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5932 @end deffn
5933 @end deffn
5934
5935 @anchor{atsame5}
5936 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5937 @cindex atsame5
5938 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5939 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5940 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5941
5942 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5943 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5944 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5945
5946 @example
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5948 @end example
5949
5950 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5951 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5952 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5953 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5954 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5955 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5956
5957 @example
5958 atsame5 bootloader
5959 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5960 @end example
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5964 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5965 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5966 processor to be halted.
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5970 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5971 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5972 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5976 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5977 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5978 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5979 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5980 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5981 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5982 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5983
5984 @example
5985 # Read
5986 >atsame5 userpage
5987 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5988 # Write
5989 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5990 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5991 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5992 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5993 @end example
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @end deffn
5997
5998 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5999 @cindex atsamv
6000 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6001 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6002 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6003 @end deffn
6004
6005 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6006 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6007 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6008 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6009 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6010
6011 @example
6012 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6013 @end example
6014
6015 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6016 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6017
6018 @itemize
6019 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6020 @item @var{banks}
6021 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6022 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6023 @item @var{pages_size}
6024 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6025 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6026 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6027 @end itemize
6028
6029 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6030 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6031 will be autoconfigured.
6032 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6033
6034 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6035 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6036 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6037 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6038 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6039
6040 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6041 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6042 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6043 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6044 are not truly general purpose).
6045 @quotation Note
6046 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6047 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6048 @end quotation
6049 @end deffn
6050 @end deffn
6051
6052 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6053 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6054 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6055 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6059 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6060 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6061 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6062
6063 @example
6064 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6065 @end example
6066
6067 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6068 each single sector one by one.
6069
6070 @example
6071 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6072 @end example
6073
6074 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6075 @end deffn
6076
6077 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6078 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6079 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6080 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6081 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6082 starts at address 0.
6083
6084 @example
6085 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6086 @end example
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6090 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6091 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6092 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6093 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6094 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6095 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6096 and programming the serial flash.
6097
6098 @example
6099 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6100 @end example
6101 @end deffn
6102
6103 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6104 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6105 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6106 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6107 autoconfigures itself.
6108 @example
6109 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6110 @end example
6111 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6112 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6113 this via the following command:
6114 @example
6115 efm32 debuglock num
6116 @end example
6117 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6118 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6119 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6120 supported.}
6121 @end deffn
6122
6123 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6124 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6125 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6126 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6127 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6128 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6129
6130 @example
6131 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6132 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6133 @end example
6134
6135 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6136 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6137 @end deffn
6138
6139 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6140 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6141 is an uncommon operation.}
6142 @end deffn
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6146 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6147 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6148 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6149 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6150 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6151 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6152
6153 @example
6154 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6155 @end example
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6159 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6160 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6161 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6162 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6163 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6164 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6165 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6166 characters) ignored.
6167
6168 @example
6169 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6170 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6171 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6172 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6173 @end example
6174 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6175 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6179 @cindex kinetis
6180 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6181 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6182 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6183 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6184 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6185 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6186
6187 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6188 @itemize
6189 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6190 @end itemize
6191
6192 @example
6193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6194 @end example
6195
6196 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6197 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6198 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6199 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6203 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6204 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6205 set by 'flash protect' command.
6206 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6207 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6208 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6209 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6210 with the rest of a flash image.
6211 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6215 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6216 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6217 @end deffn
6218
6219 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6220 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6221 and examine-fail event.
6222 @end deffn
6223
6224 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6225 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6226 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6227 @end deffn
6228
6229 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6230 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6231 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6232 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6233 command completes.
6234 @end deffn
6235
6236 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6237 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6238 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6239 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6240 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6241
6242 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6243 Program Partition command.
6244
6245 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6246 Reset the device after partition setting.
6247
6248 Show partition size:
6249 @example
6250 kinetis nvm_partition info
6251 @end example
6252
6253 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6254 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6255 @example
6256 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6257 @end example
6258
6259 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6260 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6261 @example
6262 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6263 @end example
6264 @end deffn
6265
6266 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6267 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6268 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6269 @end deffn
6270
6271 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6272 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6273 Command disables watchdog timer.
6274 @end deffn
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6278 @cindex kinetis_ke
6279 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6280 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6281 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6282 autoconfigures itself.
6283 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6284
6285 @example
6286 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6287 @end example
6288
6289 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6290 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6291 @end deffn
6292
6293 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6294 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6295 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6296 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6297 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6298 @end deffn
6299
6300 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6301 Command disables watchdog timer.
6302 @end deffn
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6306 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6307 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6308 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6309 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6310
6311 @quotation Note
6312 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6313 driver:
6314 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6315 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6316 @end quotation
6317
6318 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6319 which must appear in the following order:
6320
6321 @itemize
6322 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6323 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6324 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6325 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6326 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6327 LPC43x[2357])
6328 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6329 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6330 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6331 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6332 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6333 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6334 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6335 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6336 at which the core is running
6337 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6338 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6339 @quotation Note
6340 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6341 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6342 However, if you do provide it,
6343 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6344 @end quotation
6345 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6346 ROM IAP entry point.
6347 @end itemize
6348
6349 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6350
6351 @example
6352 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6353 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6354 @end example
6355
6356 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6357 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6358 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6359 @end deffn
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6363 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6364 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6365 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6366 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6367 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6368
6369 @example
6370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6371 @end example
6372 @end deffn
6373
6374 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6375 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6376 from NXP.
6377
6378 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6379 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6380 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6381 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6382 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6383 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6384 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6385 you start the PLL.
6386
6387 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6388
6389 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6390 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6391 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6392
6393 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6394 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6395 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6396 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6397 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6398 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6399 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6400
6401 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6402 @example
6403 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6404 @end example
6405
6406 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6407 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6408 @code{flash banks} command.
6409
6410 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6411 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6412 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6413 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6414 a known signature.
6415 Example:
6416 @example
6417 lpc2900 signature 0
6418 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6419 @end example
6420 @end deffn
6421
6422 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6423 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6424 saves it to a file in binary format.
6425 Example:
6426 @example
6427 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6428 @end example
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6432 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6433 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6434 command:
6435
6436 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6437 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6438 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6439 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6440
6441 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6442 Example:
6443 @example
6444 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6445 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6446 @end example
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6450 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6451 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6452 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6453 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6454 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6455 912 bytes.
6456 @quotation Attention
6457 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6458 @end quotation
6459 Example:
6460 @example
6461 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6462 @end example
6463 @end deffn
6464
6465 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6466 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6467 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6468 after the next power cycle.
6469 @quotation Attention
6470 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6471 @end quotation
6472 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6473 Example:
6474 @example
6475 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6476 flash info 0
6477 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6478 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6479 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6480 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6481 @end example
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6485 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6486 effective after the next power cycle.
6487 @quotation Attention
6488 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6489 @end quotation
6490 Examples:
6491 @example
6492 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6493 @end example
6494 @end deffn
6495 @end deffn
6496
6497 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6498 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6499 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6500 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6501
6502 @example
6503 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6504 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6505 @end example
6506
6507 @itemize @bullet
6508 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6509 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6510 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6511 @end itemize
6512
6513 Example usage:
6514 @example
6515 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6516 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6517 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6518 @} else @{
6519 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6520 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6521 @}
6522 @end example
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6526 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6527 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6528 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6529 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6530 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6531
6532 @example
6533 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6534 @end example
6535
6536 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6537 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6538 only the main program flash.
6539
6540 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6541 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6542 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6546 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6547 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6548 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6549
6550 To erase and program the BSL:
6551 @example
6552 msp432 bsl unlock
6553 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6554 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6555 msp432 bsl lock
6556 @end example
6557 @end deffn
6558 @end deffn
6559
6560 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6561 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6562 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6563 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6564 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6565 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6566 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6567 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6568 also have division into regions: main and info.
6569 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6570 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6571
6572 @example
6573 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6574 @end example
6575
6576 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6577
6578 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6579 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6580 @end deffn
6581
6582 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6583 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6584 @end deffn
6585
6586 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6587 Erase all userflash including info region.
6588 @end deffn
6589
6590 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6591 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6592 @end deffn
6593
6594 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6595 Check sectors protect.
6596 @end deffn
6597
6598 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6599 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6603 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6607 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6608 @end deffn
6609
6610 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6611 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6615 Show information about flash driver.
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6621 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6622 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6623 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6624 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6625
6626 @example
6627 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6628 @end example
6629
6630 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6631
6632 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6633 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6634 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6635 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6636 code.
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6640 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @end deffn
6644
6645 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6646 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6647 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6648
6649 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6650 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6651 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6652 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6653
6654 @example
6655 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6656 @end example
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6660 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6661 and integrate flash memory.
6662
6663 @example
6664 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6665 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6666 @end example
6667
6668 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6669 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6670 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6671 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6672 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6673 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6674 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6675 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6676 @end deffn
6677 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6678 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6679 This will remove any Code Protection.
6680 @end deffn
6681 @end deffn
6682
6683 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6684 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6685 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6686 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6687 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6688
6689 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6690 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6691
6692 @example
6693 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6694 @end example
6695
6696 psoc4-specific commands
6697 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6698 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6699
6700 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6701 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6702
6703 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6704 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6705 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6706
6707 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6708 @end deffn
6709
6710 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6711 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6712
6713 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6714 @end deffn
6715 @end deffn
6716
6717 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6718 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6719 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6720 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6721 apart from the base address.
6722
6723 @example
6724 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6725 @end example
6726
6727 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6728 @quotation Attention
6729 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6730 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6731 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6732 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6733 @end quotation
6734
6735 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6736
6737 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6738 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6739 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6740 @end deffn
6741 @end deffn
6742
6743 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6744 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6745 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6746 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6747 apart from the base address.
6748
6749 @example
6750 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6751 @end example
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6755 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6756 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6757 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6758
6759 @example
6760 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6761 @end example
6762
6763 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6764
6765 @itemize
6766 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6767 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6768 @end itemize
6769
6770 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6771
6772 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6773 @quotation Attention
6774 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6775 after successful write.
6776 @end quotation
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6780 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6781 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6782 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6783
6784 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6785 @itemize @bullet
6786 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6787 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6788 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6789 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6790 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6791 row size: 512 bytes.
6792 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6793 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6794 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6795 operation will erase row automatically.
6796 @end itemize
6797
6798 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6799 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6800
6801 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6802
6803 @example
6804 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6805 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6806 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6807 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6808 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6809 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6810
6811 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6812 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6813 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6814 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6815 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6816 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6817 @end example
6818
6819 psoc6-specific commands
6820 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6821 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6822 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6823 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6824 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6825 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6829 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6830 by @command{flash banks}.
6831 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6832 @end deffn
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6836 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6837 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6838 and SWD interface.
6839 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6840 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6844 @end example
6845
6846 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6847
6848 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6849 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6850 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6854 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6855 @end deffn
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6859 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6860 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6861 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6862 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6863
6864 @example
6865 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6866 @end example
6867
6868 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6869 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6870 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6871 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6872 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6873 disabled.
6874
6875 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6876 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6877 @quotation Warning
6878 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6879 applied to all of them.
6880 @end quotation
6881 @end deffn
6882 @end deffn
6883
6884 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6885 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6886 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6887 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6888 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6889
6890 @example
6891 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6892 @end example
6893
6894 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6895 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6896 the flash driver.
6897
6898 @example
6899 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6900 @end example
6901
6902 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6903 as per the following example.
6904 @example
6905 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6906 @end example
6907
6908 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6909
6910 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6911 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6912 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6916 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6917 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6918 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6919 @end deffn
6920
6921 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6922 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6923 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6924 @end deffn
6925
6926 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6927 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6928 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6929 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6930 @end deffn
6931
6932 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6933 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6934 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6935 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6939 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6940 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6941 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6942 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6943 @end deffn
6944 @end deffn
6945
6946 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6947 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6948 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6949 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6950 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6951
6952 @example
6953 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6954 @end example
6955
6956 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6957 as per the following example.
6958 @example
6959 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6960 @end example
6961
6962 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6963 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6964 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6965 @end deffn
6966
6967 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6968 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6969 the flash driver.
6970
6971 @example
6972 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6973 @end example
6974
6975 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6976
6977 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6978 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6979 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6980 @end deffn
6981
6982 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6983 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6984 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6985 @end deffn
6986
6987 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6988 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6989 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6990 @end deffn
6991
6992 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6993 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6994 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6995 @end deffn
6996
6997 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6998 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6999 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7000 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7001 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7002 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7003 @end deffn
7004
7005 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7006 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7007 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7008 @end deffn
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7012 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7013 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7014 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7015 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7016
7017 @example
7018 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7019 @end example
7020
7021 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7022 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7023 the flash driver.
7024
7025 @example
7026 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7027 @end example
7028
7029 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7030
7031 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7032 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7033 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7034 @end deffn
7035
7036 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7037 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7038 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7042 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7043 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7044 @end deffn
7045
7046 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7047 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7048 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7049 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7050 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7051
7052 Example usage:
7053 @example
7054 # read OPTSR_CUR
7055 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7056 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7057 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7058 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7059 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7060 @end example
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7064 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7065 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7066 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7067 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7068 will be touched).
7069
7070 Example usage:
7071 @example
7072 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7073 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7074 @end example
7075 @end deffn
7076 @end deffn
7077
7078 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7079 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7080 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7081 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7082 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7083
7084 @example
7085 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7086 @end example
7087
7088 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7089 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7090 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7091 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7092 second bank.
7093
7094 @example
7095 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7096 @end example
7097
7098 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7099
7100 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7101 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7102 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7106 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7107 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7108 @end deffn
7109
7110 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7111 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7112 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7113 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7114 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7115 @end deffn
7116 @end deffn
7117
7118 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7119 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
7120 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7121 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
7122 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
7123 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7124 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7125
7126 @example
7127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7128 @end example
7129
7130 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7131 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7132 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7133 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7134
7135 @example
7136 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7137 @end example
7138
7139 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7140
7141 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7142 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7147 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7148 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7152 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7153 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7154 @end deffn
7155
7156 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7157 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7158 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7159 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7160
7161 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7162 @example
7163 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7164 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7165 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7166 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7167 @end example
7168
7169 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7170 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7174 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7175 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7176 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7177 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7178
7179 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7180 @example
7181 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7182 @end example
7183
7184 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7185 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7186 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7187 @end deffn
7188
7189 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7190 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7191 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7192 @end deffn
7193 @end deffn
7194
7195 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7196 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7197 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7198 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7199 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7200
7201 @example
7202 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7203 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7204 @end example
7205
7206 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7207 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7208 for the specified flash bank.
7209 @end deffn
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7213 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7214 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7215 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7216 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7217
7218 @example
7219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7220 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7221 @end example
7222
7223 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7224 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7225 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7226
7227 @itemize @bullet
7228 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7229 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7230 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7231 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7232 @end itemize
7233 @end deffn
7234
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7238 @cindex str9xpec
7239
7240 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7241 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7242 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7243 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7244
7245 Here is some background info to help
7246 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7247 the str9:
7248 @enumerate
7249 @item
7250 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7251 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7252 @item
7253 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7254 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7255 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7256 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7257 @end enumerate
7258
7259 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7260 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7261 configured for flash bank 0.
7262 @example
7263 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7264 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7265 adapter assert srst
7266 # turn off target polling
7267 poll off
7268 # disable str9 core
7269 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7270 # read option bytes
7271 str9xpec options_read 0
7272 # re-enable str9 core
7273 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7274 poll on
7275 reset halt
7276 @end example
7277 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7278 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7279 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7280 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7281
7282 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7283
7284 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7285 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7289 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7290 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7294 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7295 erase the device.
7296 @end deffn
7297
7298 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7299 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7300 @end deffn
7301
7302 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7303 Configure str9 boot bank.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7307 Configure str9 lvd source.
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7311 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7315 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7319 Read str9 option bytes.
7320 @end deffn
7321
7322 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7323 Write str9 option bytes.
7324 @end deffn
7325
7326 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7327 unlock str9 device.
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @end deffn
7331
7332 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7333 @cindex swm050
7334 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7335
7336 @example
7337 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7338 @end example
7339
7340 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7341
7342 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7343 Erases the entire flash bank.
7344 @end deffn
7345
7346 @end deffn
7347
7348
7349 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7350 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7351 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7352 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7353
7354 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7355
7356 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7357 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7361 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7365 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7366 the flash clock.
7367 @end deffn
7368 @end deffn
7369
7370 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7371 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7372 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7373 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7374 correct bank config.
7375
7376 @example
7377 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7378 @end example
7379 @end deffn
7380
7381 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7382 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7383 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7384 @end deffn
7385
7386 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7387 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7388 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7389
7390 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7391
7392 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7393 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7397 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @section NAND Flash Commands
7403 @cindex NAND
7404
7405 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7406 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7407 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7408
7409 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7410 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7411 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7412 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7413 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7414 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7415
7416 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7417 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7418 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7419 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7420 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7421 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7422 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7423 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7424 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7425 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7426
7427 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7428 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7429 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7430 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7431 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7432 every 512 bytes of data.
7433
7434 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7435 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7436 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7437 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7438 ECC mode is used.
7439
7440 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7441 @enumerate
7442 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7443 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7444 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7445 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7446 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7447 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7448 to access that device.
7449 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7450 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7451 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7452 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7453 de-brick a board.
7454 @end enumerate
7455
7456 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7457 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7458 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7459 are only 32 bits wide.
7460 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7461 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7462 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7463 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7464
7465 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7466 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7467 @cindex NAND configuration
7468
7469 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7470 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7471 OpenOCD has initialized.
7472
7473 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7474 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7475 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7476 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7477 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7478 they were a single (larger) device.
7479 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7480 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7481
7482 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7483 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7484 configuration files, not interactively.
7485
7486 @itemize @bullet
7487 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7488 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7489 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7490 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7491 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7492 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7493 commands to the NAND controller.
7494 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7495 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7496 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7497 for more information.
7498 @end itemize
7499 @end deffn
7500
7501 @deffn Command {nand list}
7502 Prints a summary of each device declared
7503 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7504 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7505 @example
7506 > nand list
7507 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7508 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7509 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7510 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7511 >
7512 @end example
7513 @end deffn
7514
7515 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7516 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7517 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7518 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7519 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7520 it with most other NAND commands.
7521 @end deffn
7522
7523 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7524
7525 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7526 @cindex NAND reading
7527 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7528 starting at the specified offset.
7529 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7530
7531 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7532 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7533
7534 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7535 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7536 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7537
7538 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7539 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7540 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7541 method which handled that error correction.
7542
7543 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7544 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7545 @itemize @bullet
7546 @item no oob_* parameter
7547 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7548 @item @code{oob_raw}
7549 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7550 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7551 spare areas associated with each data page.
7552 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7553 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7554 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7555 @item @code{oob_only}
7556 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7557 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7558 spare areas associated with each data page.
7559 @end itemize
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7563 @cindex NAND erasing
7564 @cindex NAND programming
7565 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7566 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7567 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7568 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7569 If those parameters are not specified,
7570 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7571 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7572
7573 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7574 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7575 block marker.
7576 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7577 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7581 @cindex NAND writing
7582 @cindex NAND programming
7583 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7584 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7585 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7586 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7587
7588 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7589 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7590
7591 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7592 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7593 past the end of the device.
7594 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7595 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7596 if that's being written.)
7597
7598 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7599 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7600 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7601
7602 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7603 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7604 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7605 @itemize @bullet
7606 @item no oob_* parameter
7607 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7608 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7609 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7610 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7611 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7612 @item @code{oob_only}
7613 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7614 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7615 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7616 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7617 @item @code{oob_raw}
7618 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7619 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7620 un-altered OOB.
7621 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7622 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7623 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7624 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7625 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7626 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7627 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7628 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7629 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7630 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7631 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7632 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7633 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7634 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7635 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7636 @end itemize
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7640 @cindex NAND verification
7641 @cindex NAND programming
7642 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7643 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7644 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7645
7646 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7647 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7648
7649 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7650 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7651 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7652 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7653 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7654
7655 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7656 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7657 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7658
7659 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7660 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7661 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7662 be removed in a future release.
7663 @end deffn
7664
7665 @subsection Other NAND commands
7666 @cindex NAND other commands
7667
7668 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7669 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7670 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7671 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7672 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7673 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7674 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7675 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7676
7677 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7678 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7679 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7683 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7684 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7685 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7686 status for each block.
7687 @end deffn
7688
7689 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7690 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7691 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7692
7693 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7694 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7695 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7696 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7697 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7698
7699 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7700 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7701 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7702 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7703 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7704 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7705 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7706 @end deffn
7707
7708 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7709 @subsection NAND Driver List
7710 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7711 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7712 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7713
7714 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7715 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7716 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7717 address of the ECC controller.
7718 @example
7719 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7720 @end example
7721 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7722 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7723 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7724 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7725 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7726 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7727 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7728 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7729 @end deffn
7730 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7731 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7732 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7733 @end deffn
7734
7735 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7736 properly configured for input or output.
7737 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7738 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7739 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7740 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7741 @end deffn
7742 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7743 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7744 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7745 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7746 @end deffn
7747 @end deffn
7748
7749 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7750 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7751 chips from Texas Instruments.
7752 It takes three extra parameters:
7753 address of the NAND chip;
7754 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7755 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7756 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7757 @example
7758 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7759 @end example
7760 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7761 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7762 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7763 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7764 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7765 @end deffn
7766
7767 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7768 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7769 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7770 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7771 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7772 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7773 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7774 @end deffn
7775
7776 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7777 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7778 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7779 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7780 @end deffn
7781 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7782
7783 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7784 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7785 should work for this chip as well.
7786 @end deffn
7787
7788 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7789 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7790 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7791 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7792 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7793 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7794 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7795 @example
7796 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7797 @end example
7798 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7799 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7800 without parameter query status.
7801 @end deffn
7802 @end deffn
7803
7804 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7805 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7806 parameter: the address of the controller.
7807 @example
7808 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7809 @end example
7810 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7811 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7812 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7813 change any behavior.
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7817 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7818 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7819 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7820 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7821 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7822 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7823 specialized commands.
7824 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7825 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7826 change any behavior.
7827 @end deffn
7828
7829 @node Flash Programming
7830 @chapter Flash Programming
7831
7832 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7833 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7834 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7835
7836 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7837 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7838
7839 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7840 @enumerate
7841 @item 'init' is executed.
7842 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7843 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7844 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7845 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7846 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7847 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7848 @end enumerate
7849
7850 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7851
7852 @example
7853 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7854 # are optional parameters
7855 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7856 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7857
7858 # binary files need the flash address passing
7859 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7860 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7861 @end example
7862
7863 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7864 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7865 @cindex PLD
7866 @cindex FPGA
7867
7868 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7869 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7870 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7871 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7872 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7873 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7874 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7875
7876 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7877
7878 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7879 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7880 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7881
7882 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7883 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7884
7885 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7886 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7887 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7888 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7889 behavior.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7893 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7897 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7898 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7899 @end deffn
7900
7901 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7902
7903 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7904 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7905 that particular type of PLD.
7906
7907 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7908 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7909 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7910
7911 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7912 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7913 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7914
7915 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7916 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7917 for FPGA @var{num}.
7918 @end deffn
7919 @end deffn
7920
7921 @node General Commands
7922 @chapter General Commands
7923 @cindex commands
7924
7925 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7926 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7927 commands are documented elsewhere.
7928
7929 Intent:
7930 @itemize @bullet
7931 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7932 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7933 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7934 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7935
7936 @item @b{From the human}
7937 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7938 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7939
7940 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7941 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7942 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7943
7944 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7945 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7946 port is 5555.
7947 @end itemize
7948
7949
7950 @section Server Commands
7951
7952 @deffn {Command} exit
7953 Exits the current telnet session.
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7957 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7958 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7959 Not every command provides helptext.
7960
7961 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7962 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7963 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7964 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7968 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7969 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7970 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7971 Useful in connection with script files
7972 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7976 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7977 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7978 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7979
7980 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7981 @example
7982 # redefine shutdown
7983 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7984 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7985 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7986 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7987 original_shutdown
7988 @}
7989 @end example
7990 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7991 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @anchor{debuglevel}
7995 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7996 @cindex message level
7997 Display debug level.
7998 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7999 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8000 Level 0 is error messages only;
8001 level 1 adds warnings;
8002 level 2 adds informational messages;
8003 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8004 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8005 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8006 the command line along with the location of that log
8007 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8008 @xref{Running}.
8009 @end deffn
8010
8011 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8012 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8013 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8014 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8015 @example
8016 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8017 @end example
8018 @end deffn
8019
8020 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8021 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8022 the default log output channel is stderr.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8026 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8027 @end deffn
8028
8029 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8030 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8031 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8032 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8033 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8034 @end deffn
8035
8036 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8037 @section Target State handling
8038 @cindex reset
8039 @cindex halt
8040 @cindex target initialization
8041
8042 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8043 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8044 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8045 a current target which is used to perform the
8046 various operations. The current target may be changed
8047 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8048 target which should become current.
8049
8050 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8051 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8052 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8053 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8054 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8055
8056 @emph{With no arguments}:
8057 list all available registers for the current target,
8058 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8059 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8060 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8061 are flagged as such.
8062
8063 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8064 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8065 bypassing any internal cache.
8066
8067 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8068 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8069 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8070 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8071 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8072 relevant module will flush such values.
8073
8074 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8075 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8076
8077 @example
8078 > reg
8079 ===== ARM registers
8080 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8081 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8082 (2) r2 (/32)
8083 ...
8084 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8085 >
8086 @end example
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8090 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8091 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8092 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8093 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8094 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8095 (and enter debug mode).
8096 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8097
8098 @quotation Warning
8099 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8100 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8101 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8102 power mode by gating the core clock;
8103 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8104
8105 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8106 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8107 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8108 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8109 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8110 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8111
8112 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8113 work with a JTAG debugger.
8114 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8115 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8116 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8117 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8118 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8119 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8120 @end quotation
8121
8122 @end deffn
8123
8124 @deffn Command resume [address]
8125 Resume the target at its current code position,
8126 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8127 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8128 @end deffn
8129
8130 @deffn Command step [address]
8131 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8132 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8133 @end deffn
8134
8135 @anchor{resetcommand}
8136 @deffn Command reset
8137 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8138 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8139 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8140 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8141 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8142 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8143
8144 The optional parameter specifies what should
8145 happen after the reset.
8146 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8147 The other options will not work on all systems.
8148 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8149
8150 @itemize @minus
8151 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8152 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8153 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8154 @end itemize
8155 @end deffn
8156
8157 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8158 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8159 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8160 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8161 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8162 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8163 state.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8167 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8168 Set values of reset signals.
8169 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8170 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8171 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8172 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8173
8174 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8175 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8176 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8177 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8178 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8179 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8180 the signal will not be modified.
8181
8182 @quotation Note
8183 TRST is specially handled.
8184 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8185 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8186 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8187 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8188 instead of the TRST signal.
8189 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8190 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8191 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8192 with handlers for that event.
8193 @end quotation
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @section I/O Utilities
8197
8198 These commands are available when
8199 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8200 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8201 notably the ZY1000.
8202 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8203
8204 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8205
8206 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8207 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8208 the text file @file{filename}.
8209 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8210 The last string is followed by a newline.
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @deffn Command cat filename
8214 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8215 @end deffn
8216
8217 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8218 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8219 into @file{dest_filename}.
8220 @end deffn
8221
8222 @deffn Command ip
8223 @emph{No description provided.}
8224 @end deffn
8225
8226 @deffn Command ls
8227 @emph{No description provided.}
8228 @end deffn
8229
8230 @deffn Command mac
8231 @emph{No description provided.}
8232 @end deffn
8233
8234 @deffn Command meminfo
8235 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8236 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8237 @end deffn
8238
8239 @deffn Command peek
8240 @emph{No description provided.}
8241 @end deffn
8242
8243 @deffn Command poke
8244 @emph{No description provided.}
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247 @deffn Command rm filename
8248 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8249 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8250 @end deffn
8251
8252 @deffn Command trunc filename
8253 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8254 @end deffn
8255
8256 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8257 @section Memory access commands
8258 @cindex memory access
8259
8260 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8261 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8262 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8263 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8264
8265 @enumerate
8266 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8267 to change the current target.
8268 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8269 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8270 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8271 @end enumerate
8272
8273 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8274 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8275 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8276 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8277 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8278 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8279 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8280 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8281 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8282 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8283 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8284 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8285 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8286 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8287 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8288 @end deffn
8289
8290 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8291 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8292 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8293 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8294 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8295 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8296 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8297 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8298 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8299 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8300 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8301 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8302 @end deffn
8303
8304 @anchor{imageaccess}
8305 @section Image loading commands
8306 @cindex image loading
8307 @cindex image dumping
8308
8309 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8310 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8311 binary file named @var{filename}.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8315 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8316 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8317 @end deffn
8318
8319 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8320 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8321 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8322 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8323 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8324 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8325 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8326 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8327 separately.
8328 @end deffn
8329
8330 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8331 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8332 The file format may optionally be specified
8333 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8334 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8335 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8336 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8337 @example
8338 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8339 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8340 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8341 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8342 $address $length
8343 @}
8344 @end example
8345 @end deffn
8346
8347 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8348 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8349 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8350 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8351 The file format may optionally be specified
8352 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8353 @end deffn
8354
8355 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8356 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8357 The file format may optionally be specified
8358 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8359 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8360 @end deffn
8361
8362 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8363 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8364 The file format may optionally be specified
8365 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8366 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369
8370 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8371 @cindex breakpoint
8372 @cindex watchpoint
8373
8374 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8375 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8376 watchpoints.
8377 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8378
8379 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8380 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8381 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8382 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8383 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8384 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8385
8386 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8387 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8388 @end deffn
8389
8390 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8391 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8392 @end deffn
8393
8394 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8395 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8396 @end deffn
8397
8398 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8399 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8400 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8401 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8402 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8403 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8404 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8405 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8406 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 @section Misc Commands
8410
8411 @cindex profiling
8412 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8413 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8414 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8415 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8416 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8417 limit the address range.
8418 @end deffn
8419
8420 @deffn Command {version}
8421 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8422 @end deffn
8423
8424 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8425 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8426 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8427 @end deffn
8428
8429 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8430 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8431 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8432 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8433
8434 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8435 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8436 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8437 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8438
8439 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8440 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8441 @cindex tracing
8442 @cindex ETM
8443 @cindex ETB
8444
8445 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8446 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8447 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8448
8449 @itemize
8450 @item
8451 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8452 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8453 supports such an interface.
8454 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8455 and trace port support.)
8456 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8457 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8458 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8459 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8460 in the board-specific configuration file.
8461 @item
8462 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8463 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8464 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8465 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8466 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8467 @end itemize
8468
8469 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8470
8471 @quotation Issues
8472 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8473 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8474
8475 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8476 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8477 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8478 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8479 dummy trace port driver}.
8480
8481 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8482 as well as tracing only during specific states
8483 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8484
8485 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8486 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8487 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8488 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8489 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8490
8491 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8492 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8493 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8494 this original style of JTAG access.
8495 @end quotation
8496
8497 @subsection ETM Configuration
8498 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8499
8500 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8501 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8502 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8503
8504 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8505 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8506 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8507 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8508 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8509 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8510 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8511 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8512 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8513
8514 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8515 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8516 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8517
8518 @quotation Warning
8519 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8520 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8521 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8522 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8523 @end quotation
8524
8525 @quotation Note
8526 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8527 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8528 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8529 what CPU activities are traced.
8530 @end quotation
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 @deffn Command {etm info}
8534 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8535 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8536 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8537 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn Command {etm status}
8541 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8542 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8543 Did trace data overflow?
8544 Was it triggered?
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8548 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8549 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8550 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8551 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8552
8553 @itemize
8554 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8555 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8556 The value is one of
8557 @option{none} (save nothing),
8558 @option{data} (save data),
8559 @option{address} (save addresses),
8560 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8561 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8562 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8563 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8564 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8565 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8566 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8567 trace stream without an image of the code.
8568 @end itemize
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8572 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8573 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8574 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8575 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8576
8577 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8578 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8579 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8580 @end deffn
8581
8582 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8583
8584 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8585 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8586 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8587
8588 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8589 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8590 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8591 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8592 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8593 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8594 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8595
8596 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8597
8598 @itemize
8599 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8600 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8601 for instruction access within that function's body.
8602 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8603 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8604 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8605 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8606 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8607 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8608 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8609 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8610 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8611 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8612 @item @emph{... more}
8613 @end itemize
8614
8615 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8616 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8617
8618 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8619 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8620 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8624 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8625 @end deffn
8626
8627 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8628 Opens an image file.
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8632 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8633 @end deffn
8634
8635 @deffn Command {etm start}
8636 Starts trace data collection.
8637 @end deffn
8638
8639 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8640 Stops trace data collection.
8641 @end deffn
8642
8643 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8644 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8645
8646 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8647
8648 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8649 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8650 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8651 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8652 any trace data collection.}
8653 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8654 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8655 @end deffn
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8659 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8660 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8661 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8662 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8663 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8664 @end deffn
8665 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8666 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8667 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8668 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8669 trace trigger becomes active.
8670
8671 @itemize
8672 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8673 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8674 afterwards.
8675 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8676 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8677 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8678 what caused that event to happen.
8679 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8680 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8681 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8682 how the event caused trouble.
8683 @end itemize
8684 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8690 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8691 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8692 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8693 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8694
8695 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8696 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8697
8698 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8699 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8700 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8701 @end deffn
8702
8703 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8704 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8705 @end deffn
8706
8707 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8708 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8709 @end deffn
8710 @end deffn
8711
8712 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8713 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8714 @cindex CTI
8715
8716 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8717 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8718 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8719 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8720 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8721 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8722
8723 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8724 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8725 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8726 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8727 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8728 including additional configuration.
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8732 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8733 @end deffn
8734
8735 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8736 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8737 @end deffn
8738
8739 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8740 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8741 @end deffn
8742
8743 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8744 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8745 @end deffn
8746
8747 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8748 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8749 @end deffn
8750
8751 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8752 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8753 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8754 @end deffn
8755
8756 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8757 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8758 of the CTI.
8759 @end deffn
8760
8761 @deffn Command {cti names}
8762 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8763 useful in TCL scripting.
8764 @end deffn
8765
8766 @section Generic ARM
8767 @cindex ARM
8768
8769 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8770 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8771 commands that may be available.
8772
8773 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8774 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8775 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8776 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8777 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8778 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8779 @end deffn
8780
8781 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8782 @cindex disassemble
8783 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8784 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8785 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8786 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8787 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8788 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8789 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8790
8791 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8792 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8793 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8794 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8795 with a handful of exceptions.
8796 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8797 @end deffn
8798
8799 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8800 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8801 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8802 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8803 and using the MCR instruction.
8804 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8805 an ARM register.)
8806 @end deffn
8807
8808 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8809 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8810 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8811 and the MRC instruction.
8812 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8813 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8814 an ARM register.)
8815 @end deffn
8816
8817 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8818 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8819 core mode if necessary.
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8823 @cindex ARM semihosting
8824 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8825
8826 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8827 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8828 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8829 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8830 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8831 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8832 @end deffn
8833
8834 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8835 @cindex ARM semihosting
8836 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8837
8838 @example
8839 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8840 @end example
8841
8842 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8843 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8844 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8845 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8846 @end deffn
8847
8848 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8849 @cindex ARM semihosting
8850 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8851 status.
8852
8853 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8854 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8855 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8856 debugger.
8857 @end deffn
8858
8859 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8860 @cindex ARM semihosting
8861 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8862
8863 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8864 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8865 the value returned by the target.
8866
8867 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8868 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8869 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8870 encountering a break.
8871
8872 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8873 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8874 to the debugger.
8875 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8876 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8877 request or equivalent").
8878
8879 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8880 this option (default: disabled).
8881 @end deffn
8882
8883 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8884 @cindex ARMv4
8885 @cindex ARMv5
8886
8887 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8888 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8889 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8890 variant.
8891
8892 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8893 @cindex ARM7
8894 @cindex ARM9
8895
8896 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8897 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8898 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8899 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8900
8901 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8902 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8903 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8904 instead of breakpoints.
8905 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8906
8907 This should be
8908 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8909 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8910 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8911 @end deffn
8912
8913 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8914 @cindex DCC
8915 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8916 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8917 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8918
8919 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8920 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8921 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8922 @end deffn
8923
8924 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8925 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8926 that don't check completion of the operation.
8927 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8928
8929 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8930 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8931 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8932 @end deffn
8933
8934 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8935 @cindex ARM720T
8936
8937 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8938 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8939 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8940 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8941
8942 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8943 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8944 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8945
8946 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8947 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8948 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8952 @cindex ARM9
8953
8954 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8955 integer processors.
8956 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8957
8958 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8959 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8960 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8961 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8962
8963 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8964 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8965 @cindex vector_catch
8966 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8967 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8968 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8969 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8970 to those hardware vectors.
8971
8972 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8973 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8974 vector catch hardware to intercept
8975 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8976 @option{none} of them,
8977 or a list with one or more of the following:
8978 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8979 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8980 @end deffn
8981
8982 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8983 @cindex ARM920T
8984
8985 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8986 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8987 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8988 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8989 and ARM9 commands.
8990
8991 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8992 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8993 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8994 @end deffn
8995
8996 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8997 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8998 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8999 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9000 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9001 (Not all registers can be written.)
9002 @end deffn
9003
9004 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
9005 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9006 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9007
9008 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
9009 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
9010 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
9011 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
9012 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
9013 or using zero if no other address is provided.
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9017 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9018 @end deffn
9019
9020 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9021 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9022 @end deffn
9023
9024 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9025 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9026
9027 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9028 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9029 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9030 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9031 and ARM9 commands.
9032
9033 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9034 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9035
9036 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9037 Print information about the caches found.
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9041 @cindex ARM966E
9042
9043 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9044 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9045 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9046 and ARM9 commands.
9047
9048 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9049 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9050 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9051 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9052 ARM966E-S TRM.
9053 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9054 as required for BIST support.
9055 @end deffn
9056
9057 @subsection XScale specific commands
9058 @cindex XScale
9059
9060 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9061
9062 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9063 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9064 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9065 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9066 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9067 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9068 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9069
9070 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9071 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9072 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9073 the mini-IC.
9074
9075 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9076 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9077 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9078 code layout in memory:
9079 @example
9080 _vectors:
9081 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9082 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9083 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9084 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9085 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9086 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9087 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9088 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9089 .org 0x100
9090 .long real_reset_vector
9091 .long real_ui_handler
9092 .long real_swi_handler
9093 .long real_pf_abort
9094 .long real_data_abort
9095 .long 0 /* unused */
9096 .long real_irq_handler
9097 .long real_fiq_handler
9098 @end example
9099
9100 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9101 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9102 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9103 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9104 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9105 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9106 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9107 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9108 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9109 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9110 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9111 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9112 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9113 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9114 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9115 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9116 software.
9117
9118 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9119 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9120 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9121 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9122
9123 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9124 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9125 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9126 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9127 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9128 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9129 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9130 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9131 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9132
9133 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9134 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9135
9136 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9137 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9138 @end deffn
9139
9140 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9141 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9145 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9146 @end deffn
9147
9148 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9149 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9150 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9151 @end deffn
9152
9153 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9154 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9158 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9159 @end deffn
9160
9161 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9162 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9166 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9167 @end deffn
9168
9169 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9170 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9174 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9175 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9176 and modifying how it is emptied.
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9180 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9181 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9182 The image @var{type} may be one of
9183 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9184 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9185 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9186 @end deffn
9187
9188 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9189 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9190 @cindex vector_catch
9191 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9192 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9193
9194 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9195 @example
9196 0x01 Trap Reset
9197 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9198 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9199 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9200 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9201 0x20 reserved
9202 0x40 Trap IRQ
9203 0x80 Trap FIQ
9204 @end example
9205 @end deffn
9206
9207 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9208 @cindex vector_table
9209
9210 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9211 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9212 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9213 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9214 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9215
9216 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9217
9218 @end deffn
9219
9220 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9221 @cindex ARMv6
9222
9223 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9224 @cindex ARM11
9225
9226 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9227 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9228 which is enabled by default.
9229 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9230 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9231 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9232 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9233 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9234 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9235 @end deffn
9236
9237 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9238 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9239 which is enabled by default.
9240 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9241 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9242 @end deffn
9243
9244 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9245 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9246 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9247 they are disabled by default.
9248 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9249 @end deffn
9250
9251 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9252 @cindex vector_catch
9253 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9254 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9255 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9256
9257 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9258 for certain hardware events.
9259 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9260 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9261 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9262 @end deffn
9263
9264 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9265 @cindex ARMv7
9266 @cindex ARMv8
9267
9268 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9269 @cindex Cortex-A
9270
9271 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9272 display information about target caches
9273 @end deffn
9274
9275 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9276 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9277 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9278 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9279 Defaults to 'off'.
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9283 Initialize core debug
9284 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9285 @end deffn
9286
9287 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9288 Display/set the current SMP mode
9289 @end deffn
9290
9291 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9292 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9293 @end deffn
9294
9295 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9296 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9297 @end deffn
9298
9299 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9300 configure l2x cache
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9304 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9305 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9306 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9307 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9311 @cindex Cortex-R
9312
9313 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9314 Initialize core debug
9315 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9316 @end deffn
9317
9318 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9319 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322
9323 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9324 @cindex tracing
9325 @cindex SWO
9326 @cindex SWV
9327 @cindex TPIU
9328 @cindex ITM
9329 @cindex ETM
9330
9331 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)}) @
9332 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9333 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9334
9335 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9336 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9337 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9338 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9339
9340 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9341 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9342 debugger adapter features.
9343
9344 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9345 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9346
9347 Command options:
9348 @itemize @minus
9349 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9350 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9351 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware).
9352 @item @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9353 gather trace data then:
9354
9355 @itemize @minus
9356 @item append it to a regular file or a named pipe if @var{filename} is specified.
9357 @item listen to a TCP/IP port if @var{:port} is specified, then broadcast the trace data over this port.
9358 @item if '-' is specified, OpenOCD will forward trace data to @command{tcl_trace} command.
9359 @*@b{Note:} while broadcasting to file or TCP, the forwarding to @command{tcl_trace} will remain active.
9360 @end itemize
9361
9362 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9363 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width}.
9364 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9365 coding.
9366 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9367 regular UART 8N1) coding.
9368 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9369 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9370 data is to be output via SWO.
9371 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9372 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK).
9373 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9374 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9375 rate automatically.
9376 @end itemize
9377
9378 Example usage:
9379 @enumerate
9380 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9381 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9382 enough to:
9383 @example
9384 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9385 ...
9386 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9387 ...
9388 @end example
9389 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9390 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9391 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9392 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9393 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9394 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9395 @example
9396 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9397 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9398 @end example
9399 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9400 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9401 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9402 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9403 @example
9404 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9405 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9406 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9407 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9408 @end example
9409 @end enumerate
9410 @end deffn
9411
9412 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9413 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9414 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9415 @end deffn
9416
9417 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9418 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9419 @end deffn
9420
9421 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9422 @cindex Cortex-M
9423
9424 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9425 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9426
9427 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9428 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9429 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9430 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9431 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9432 the step command leaves with the core running.
9433
9434 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9435 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9436 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9437 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9438
9439 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9440 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9441 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9442 does.
9443
9444 Default is @option{auto}.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9448 @cindex vector_catch
9449 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9450 for certain hardware events.
9451
9452 Parameters request interception of
9453 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9454 @option{none} of them,
9455 or one or more of the following:
9456 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9457 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9458 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9459 @option{irq_err},
9460 @option{state_err},
9461 @option{chk_err}, or
9462 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9463 @option{reset}.
9464 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9465 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9466 are mapped to HardFault.
9467 UsageFault checks for
9468 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9469 must also be explicitly enabled.
9470
9471 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9475 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9476 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9477
9478 @itemize @minus
9479 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9480 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9481 @end itemize
9482
9483 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9484 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9485 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9486 to manually reset the peripherals.
9487 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9488
9489 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9490 instead.
9491 @end deffn
9492
9493 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9494 @cindex ARMv8-A
9495 @cindex aarch64
9496
9497 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9498 Display information about target caches
9499 @end deffn
9500
9501 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9502 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9503 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9504 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9505 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9506 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9507 @end deffn
9508
9509 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9510 @cindex disassemble
9511 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9512 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9513 @end deffn
9514
9515 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9516 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9517 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9518 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9519 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9520 @end deffn
9521
9522 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9523 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9524 @option{on}.
9525 @end deffn
9526
9527 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9528 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9529 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9530 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9531 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9532 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9533 @end deffn
9534
9535 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9536
9537 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9538 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9539
9540 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9541
9542 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9543 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9544 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9545 @end deffn
9546
9547 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9548 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9549 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9550 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9551 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9552 @end deffn
9553
9554 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9555
9556 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9557 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9558 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9559 @end deffn
9560
9561 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9562
9563 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9564 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9565 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9566 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9567 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9568 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9569 can be collected.
9570
9571 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9572 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9573 tooling.
9574
9575 @quotation Issues
9576 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9577 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9578 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9579 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9580
9581 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9582 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9583 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9584 software operation on the CPU.
9585 @end quotation
9586
9587 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9588 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9589 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9590 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9591 @end deffn
9592
9593 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9594 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9595 @end deffn
9596
9597 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9598 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9599 control is disabled.
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9603 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9604 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9605 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9606
9607 Supported trace formats:
9608 @itemize
9609 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9610 timing to be determined.
9611 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9612 addresses.
9613 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9614 @end itemize
9615 @end deffn
9616
9617 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9618 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9619 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9620 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9621
9622 Supported conditions:
9623 @itemize
9624 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9625 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9626 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9627 instruction matches start data and mask.
9628 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9629 instruction matches start data and mask.
9630 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9631 data and mask.
9632 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9633 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9634 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9635 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9636 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9637 @end itemize
9638 @end deffn
9639
9640 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9641 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9642 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9643 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9644
9645 Supported conditions:
9646 @itemize
9647 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9648 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9649 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9650 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9651 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9652 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9653 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9654 data and mask.
9655 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9656 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9657 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9658 @end itemize
9659 @end deffn
9660
9661 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9662 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9663
9664 Supported triggers:
9665 @itemize
9666 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9667 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9668 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9669 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9670 collection.
9671 @end itemize
9672 @end deffn
9673
9674 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9675
9676 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9677 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9678 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9679 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9680 @end deffn
9681
9682 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9683 Display trace configuration.
9684 @end deffn
9685
9686 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9687 Display trace collection status.
9688 @end deffn
9689
9690 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9691 Start manual trace collection.
9692 @end deffn
9693
9694 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9695 Stop manual trace collection.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9699 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9700 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9701 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9702 @option{size} options using DMA.
9703 @end deffn
9704
9705 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9706 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9707 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9708 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9709 @option{size} options using DMA.
9710 @end deffn
9711
9712 @section Intel Architecture
9713
9714 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9715 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9716 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9717 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9718 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9719 @itemize
9720 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9721 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9722 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9723 @end itemize
9724
9725 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9726 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9727 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9728
9729 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9730 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9731 @end deffn
9732
9733 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9734 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9735 @end deffn
9736
9737 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9738 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9739 @end deffn
9740
9741 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9742 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9743 @end deffn
9744
9745 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9746 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9747 @end deffn
9748
9749 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9750 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9751 @end deffn
9752
9753 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9754
9755 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9756 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9757
9758 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9759 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9760 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9761 @end deffn
9762 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9763 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9764
9765 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9766
9767 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9768 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9769 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9770 @end deffn
9771
9772 @subsection Registers commands
9773 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9774 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9775 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9776
9777 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9778
9779 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9780 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9781 and "timer" groups.
9782
9783 @emph{example:}
9784 @example
9785 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9786 @end example
9787
9788
9789 @end deffn
9790 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9791 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9792
9793 @emph{group} can be "system",
9794 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9795 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9796 @end deffn
9797
9798 @section RISC-V Architecture
9799
9800 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9801 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9802 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9803 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9804 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9805 implement version 0.11.
9806
9807 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9808
9809 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9810 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9811 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9812
9813 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9814
9815 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9816 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9817 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9818
9819 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9820 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9821 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9822 CSRs.
9823 @end deffn
9824
9825 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9826 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9827 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9828 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9829 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9830 This command must be executed before `init`.
9831 @end deffn
9832
9833 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9834 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9835 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9836 @end deffn
9837
9838 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9839 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9840 deasserted.
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9844 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9845 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9846 @end deffn
9847
9848 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9849 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
9850 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
9854 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
9855 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
9856 on physical memory.
9857 @end deffn
9858
9859 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
9860 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
9861 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
9862 performed on physical memory.
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
9866 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
9867 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
9868 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
9869 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
9870 race condition problem in your code.
9871
9872 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
9873 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
9874 @end deffn
9875
9876 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9877 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9878 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9879 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9880 values.
9881
9882 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9883 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9884 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9885 @end deffn
9886
9887 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
9888 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
9889 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
9890 @end deffn
9891
9892 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
9893 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9894 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9895 @end deffn
9896
9897 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
9898 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9899 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9900 @end deffn
9901
9902 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
9903 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9904 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9905 @end deffn
9906
9907 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9908
9909 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9910 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9911 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9912 @example
9913 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9914 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9915 @end example
9916
9917 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9918 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9919 @end deffn
9920
9921 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9922 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9923 @end deffn
9924
9925 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9926
9927 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9928 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9929
9930 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
9931 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9932 @end deffn
9933
9934 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9935 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9936 @end deffn
9937
9938 @section ARC Architecture
9939 @cindex ARC
9940
9941 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9942 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9943 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9944 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9945 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9946 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9947 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9948 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9949 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9950 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9951 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9952 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9953 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9954 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9955 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9956
9957
9958 @subsection General ARC commands
9959
9960 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9961
9962 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9963 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9964 arguments:
9965
9966 @itemize @bullet
9967
9968 @item @code{-name} name
9969 @*Name of a register.
9970
9971 @item @code{-num} number
9972 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9973
9974 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9975 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9976
9977 @end itemize
9978
9979 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9980
9981 @itemize @bullet
9982
9983 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
9984 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
9985 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
9986 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
9987 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
9988 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
9989
9990 @item @code{-core}
9991 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
9992 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
9993 spaces.
9994
9995 @item @code{-bcr}
9996 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
9997 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
9998 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
9999 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10000 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10001
10002 @item @code{-type} type_name
10003 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10004 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10005
10006 @item @code{-g}
10007 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10008 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10009 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10010 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10011 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10012
10013 @end itemize
10014
10015 @end deffn
10016
10017 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10018 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10019 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10020 @end deffn
10021
10022 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10023 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10024 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10025 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10026 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10027 startbit endbit}.
10028 @end deffn
10029
10030 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10031 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10032 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10033 @end deffn
10034
10035 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10036 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10037 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10038 @end deffn
10039
10040 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10041
10042 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10043 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10044 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10045 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10046
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10050 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10051 registers.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10055 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10056 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10057 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10058
10059 @end deffn
10060
10061 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10062 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10063 registers.
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @section STM8 Architecture
10067 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10068 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10069
10070 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10071 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10072
10073 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10074 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10075 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10076 @cindex tracing
10077 @cindex libdcc
10078 @cindex DCC
10079 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10080 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10081 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10082 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10083
10084 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10085 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10086 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10087 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10088 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10089 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10090
10091 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10092 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10093 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10094 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10095 The target being debugged may
10096 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10097 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10098 each supported by a command:
10099
10100 @itemize
10101 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10102 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10103 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10104 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10105
10106 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10107 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10108 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10109
10110 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10111 and then displayed at any time.
10112 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10113
10114 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10115 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10116 @end itemize
10117
10118 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10119 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10120 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10121 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10122 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10123 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10124 does the same thing.
10125
10126 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10127 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10128 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10129 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10130 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10131
10132 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10133 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10134 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10135 @end deffn
10136
10137 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10138 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10139 in the order they triggered.
10140 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10141 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10142 history records.
10143 @end deffn
10144
10145 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10146 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10147 they have been triggered.
10148 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10149 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10150 and associates it with that identifier.
10151
10152 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10153 are not related except by this command.
10154 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10155 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10156 @end deffn
10157
10158
10159 @node JTAG Commands
10160 @chapter JTAG Commands
10161 @cindex JTAG Commands
10162 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10163 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10164 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10165 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10166 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10167
10168 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10169 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10170
10171 @itemize @bullet
10172 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10173 devices such as a CPUs.
10174 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10175 standard state machine (in parallel)
10176 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10177 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10178 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10179 while the reading previous ones.
10180 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10181 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10182 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10183 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10184 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10185 registers.
10186 @end itemize
10187
10188 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10189
10190 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10191 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10192 the order of TAP state transitions.
10193 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10194 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10195 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10196 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10197 these commands are not available.
10198
10199 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10200 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10201 that specify the entire register.
10202 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10203 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10204 The return value holds the original value of each
10205 of those fields.
10206
10207 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10208 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10209 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10210 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10211 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10212
10213 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10214 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10215
10216 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10217 in that state.
10218 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10219 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10220 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10221
10222 @quotation Warning
10223 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10224 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10225 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10226 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10227 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10228 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10229 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10230 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10231 @end quotation
10232 @end deffn
10233
10234 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10235 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10236 This may be used for performance tuning.
10237
10238 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10239 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10240 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10241 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10242 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10243 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10247 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10248 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10249 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10250 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10251 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10252
10253 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10254 in that state.
10255 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10256 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10257 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10258
10259 @quotation Note
10260 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10261 register values, unlike data register values.
10262 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10263 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10264 @end quotation
10265 @end deffn
10266
10267 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10268 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10269 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10270 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10271 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10272 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10273 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10274 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10275 The final state must also be stable.
10276 @end deffn
10277
10278 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10279 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10280 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10281 Instructions often need some time
10282 to execute before they take effect.
10283 @end deffn
10284
10285 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10286 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10287
10288 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10289 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10290 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10291 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10292 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10293 @end deffn
10294
10295 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10296 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10297 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10298 must also be enabled.
10299 Default is enabled.
10300 @end deffn
10301
10302 @section TAP state names
10303 @cindex TAP state names
10304
10305 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10306 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10307 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10308 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10309
10310 @itemize @bullet
10311 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10312 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10313 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10314 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10315 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10316 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10317 through the data register
10318 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10319 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10320 for update or more shifting
10321 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10322 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10323 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10324 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10325 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10326 through the instruction register
10327 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10328 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10329 for update or more shifting
10330 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10331 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10332 @end itemize
10333
10334 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10335 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10336 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10337 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10338
10339 @itemize @bullet
10340 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10341 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10342 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10343 may not be as expected.
10344 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10345 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10346 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10347 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10348 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10349 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10350 @end itemize
10351
10352 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10353 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10354
10355 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10356 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10357 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10358 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10359
10360 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10361 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10362 @cindex SVF
10363
10364 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10365 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10366 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10367 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10368
10369 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10370 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10371 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10372 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10373
10374 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10375 affect their semantics.
10376
10377 Command options:
10378 @itemize @minus
10379 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10380 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10381 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10382 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10383 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10384 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10385 on the real interface;
10386 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10387 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10388 errors.
10389 @end itemize
10390 @end deffn
10391
10392 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10393 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10394 @cindex XSVF
10395
10396 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10397 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10398 Xilinx devices.
10399 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10400 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10401
10402 @quotation Important
10403 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10404 @end quotation
10405
10406 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10407 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10408 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10409 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10410 that TAP.
10411 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10412 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10413 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10414 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10415 @end deffn
10416
10417 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10418 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10419 after building the software.
10420 You may find them useful:
10421
10422 @itemize
10423 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10424 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10425 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10426 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10427 @end itemize
10428
10429 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10430 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10431 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10432 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10433 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10434 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10435 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10436
10437
10438 @node Utility Commands
10439 @chapter Utility Commands
10440 @cindex Utility Commands
10441
10442 @section RAM testing
10443 @cindex RAM testing
10444
10445 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10446 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10447 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10448 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10449 hardware problems.
10450
10451 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10452 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10453 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10454 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10455
10456 Load the memory testing functions with
10457
10458 @example
10459 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10460 @end example
10461
10462 to get access to the following facilities:
10463
10464 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10465 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10466 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10467 @end deffn
10468
10469 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10470 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10471 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10472 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10473 @end deffn
10474
10475 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10476 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10477 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10478 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10479 @end deffn
10480
10481 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10482 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10483 @end deffn
10484
10485 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10486 @cindex Firmware recovery
10487
10488 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10489 devices recovery with JTAG.
10490
10491 For quickstart instructions run:
10492 @example
10493 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10494 @end example
10495
10496 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10497 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10498 @cindex GDB
10499 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10500 to debug remote targets.
10501 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10502
10503 @itemize
10504 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10505 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10506 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10507 as shown in this chapter.
10508 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10509 that also will probably need to be configured.
10510 @end itemize
10511
10512 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10513 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10514 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10515 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10516 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10517 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10518
10519 @section Connecting to GDB
10520 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10521 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10522 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10523 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10524 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10525
10526 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10527
10528 @enumerate
10529 @item
10530 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10531 @example
10532 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10533 @end example
10534 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10535
10536 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10537 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10538 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10539
10540 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10541 remote command above that becomes:
10542 @example
10543 tar ext :3333
10544 @end example
10545
10546 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10547 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10548 available through the command:
10549 @example
10550 target remote localhost:3333
10551 @end example
10552
10553 @item
10554 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10555 @example
10556 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10557 @end example
10558 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10559 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10560 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10561 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10562 @end enumerate
10563
10564 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10565 GDB command line.
10566
10567 @section Sample GDB session startup
10568
10569 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10570 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10571 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10572 small ARM program.
10573 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10574 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10575
10576 @example
10577 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10578 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10579 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10580 ...
10581 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10582 ...
10583 (gdb) load
10584 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10585 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10586 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10587 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10588 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10589 (gdb) continue
10590 Continuing.
10591 ...
10592 @end example
10593
10594 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10595 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10596 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10597 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10598
10599 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10600
10601 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10602 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10603 packet size and the device's memory map.
10604 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10605 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10606 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10607
10608 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10609 You may need to set those up by hand.
10610 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10611 something like:
10612
10613 @example
10614 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10615 @end example
10616
10617 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10618
10619 @example
10620 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10621 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10622 @end example
10623
10624 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10625 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10626 do not have such restrictions.
10627
10628 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10629 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10630 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10631 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10632
10633 @section Programming using GDB
10634 @cindex Programming using GDB
10635 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10636
10637 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10638 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10639 @example
10640 gdb_memory_map disable
10641 @end example
10642 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10643 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10644 working area.
10645
10646 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10647 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10648 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10649 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10650
10651 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10652 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10653
10654 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10655 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10656 @example
10657 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10658 @end example
10659
10660 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10661 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10662
10663 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10664 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10665 will be used.
10666
10667 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10668 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10669 @example
10670 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10671 @end example
10672 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10673
10674 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10675 can be used.
10676
10677 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10678 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10679 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10680
10681 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10682 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10683 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10684
10685 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10686 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10687 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10688 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10689 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10690 without any intrusion of the target process.
10691
10692 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10693 Place following command after target configuration:
10694 @example
10695 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10696 @end example
10697
10698 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10699 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10700 @example
10701 gdb_memory_map disable
10702 @end example
10703
10704 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10705 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10706 @example
10707 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10708 @end example
10709
10710 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10711 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10712
10713 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10714 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10715 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10716 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10717
10718 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10719 previously shown variables.
10720
10721 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10722 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10723 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10724 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10725 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10726
10727 @section RTOS Support
10728 @cindex RTOS Support
10729 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10730
10731 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10732 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10733
10734 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10735 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10736 GDB commands.
10737
10738 @* An example setup is below:
10739
10740 @example
10741 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10742 @end example
10743
10744 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10745
10746 Currently supported rtos's include:
10747 @itemize @bullet
10748 @item @option{eCos}
10749 @item @option{ThreadX}
10750 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10751 @item @option{linux}
10752 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10753 @item @option{embKernel}
10754 @item @option{mqx}
10755 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10756 @item @option{nuttx}
10757 @item @option{RIOT}
10758 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10759 @end itemize
10760
10761 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10762 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10763
10764 @table @code
10765 @item eCos symbols
10766 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10767 @item ThreadX symbols
10768 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10769 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10770 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10771 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10772 @tex
10773 \begingroup
10774 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10775 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10776 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10777 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10778 \par
10779 \endgroup
10780 @end tex
10781 @item linux symbols
10782 init_task.
10783 @item ChibiOS symbols
10784 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10785 @item embKernel symbols
10786 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10787 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10788 @item mqx symbols
10789 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10790 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10791 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10792 @item nuttx symbols
10793 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10794 @item RIOT symbols
10795 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10796 @end table
10797
10798 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10799 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10800
10801 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10802 along with the project:
10803
10804 @table @code
10805 @item FreeRTOS
10806 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10807 @item uC/OS-III
10808 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10809 @end table
10810
10811 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10812 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10813 @cindex SMP
10814 @cindex RTOS
10815 @cindex hwthread
10816 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10817 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10818 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10819 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10820 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10821 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10822 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10823 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10824 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10825
10826 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10827 @quotation Note
10828 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10829 @end quotation
10830
10831 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10832 @itemize @bullet
10833 @item j - smp status request
10834 @item J - smp set request
10835 @end itemize
10836
10837 OpenOCD implements :
10838 @itemize @bullet
10839 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10840 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10841 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10842 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10843 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10844 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10845 @end itemize
10846
10847 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10848 @itemize @bullet
10849 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10850 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10851 @example
10852 set $_core 1
10853 #Jc01 packet is sent
10854 print $_core
10855 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10856 @end example
10857
10858 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10859 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10860
10861 @example
10862 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10863 define toggle0
10864 maint packet Jc0
10865 continue
10866 main packet Jc-1
10867 end
10868 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10869 define toggle1
10870 maint packet Jc1
10871 continue
10872 main packet Jc-1
10873 end
10874 @end example
10875 @end itemize
10876
10877 @node Tcl Scripting API
10878 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10879 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10880 @cindex Tcl scripts
10881 @section API rules
10882
10883 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10884 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10885 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10886
10887 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10888 pair list and lists.
10889
10890 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10891 list.
10892
10893 @example
10894 > set foo(me) Duane
10895 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10896 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10897 > set foo(duck) Donald
10898 @end example
10899
10900 If one does this:
10901
10902 @example
10903 > set foo
10904 @end example
10905
10906 The result is:
10907
10908 @example
10909 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10910 @end example
10911
10912 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10913
10914 @verbatim
10915 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10916 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10917 }
10918 @end verbatim
10919
10920 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10921 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10922
10923 @section Internal low-level Commands
10924
10925 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10926 invoke directly.
10927
10928 @itemize @bullet
10929 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10930
10931 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10932 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10933
10934 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10935 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10936
10937 Return information about the flash banks
10938
10939 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10940
10941 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10942 its execution. Example:
10943
10944 @example
10945 > capture "reset init"
10946 @end example
10947
10948 @end itemize
10949
10950 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10951 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10952 called "flash_banks".
10953
10954 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10955
10956 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10957 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10958 holds one of the following values:
10959
10960 @itemize @bullet
10961 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10962 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10963 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10964 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10965 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10966 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10967 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10968 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10969 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10970 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10971 @end itemize
10972
10973 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10974
10975 @quotation Note
10976 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10977 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10978 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10979 is jim, not real tcl).
10980 @end quotation
10981
10982 @section Tcl RPC server
10983 @cindex RPC
10984
10985 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10986 commands and receive the results.
10987
10988 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10989 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10990 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10991 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10992 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10993
10994 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10995 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10996 @command{capture} command.
10997
10998 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10999
11000 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11001 @cindex RPC Notifications
11002
11003 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11004 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11005
11006 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11007 in the following format.
11008
11009 @verbatim
11010 type target_event event [event-name]
11011 type target_state state [state-name]
11012 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11013 @end verbatim
11014
11015 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11016 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11017 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11018 Defaults to off.
11019
11020 @end deffn
11021
11022 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11023 @cindex RPC trace output
11024
11025 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11026 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11027
11028 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11029
11030 @verbatim
11031 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11032 @end verbatim
11033
11034 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11035 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11036 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11037 Defaults to off.
11038
11039 See an example application here:
11040 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11041
11042 @end deffn
11043
11044 @node FAQ
11045 @chapter FAQ
11046 @cindex faq
11047 @enumerate
11048 @anchor{faqrtck}
11049 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11050 @cindex RTCK
11051 @cindex adaptive clocking
11052 @*
11053
11054 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11055 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11056 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11057 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11058
11059 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11060 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11061 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11062 @enumerate
11063 @item
11064 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11065 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11066 @item
11067 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11068 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11069 @end enumerate
11070
11071 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11072 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11073 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11074 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11075 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11076 power).
11077
11078 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11079 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11080 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11081 ARM926 scenario).
11082 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11083 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11084 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11085
11086 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11087 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11088 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11089 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11090
11091 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11092
11093 In order to make use of this,
11094 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11095 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11096
11097 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11098 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11099 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11100 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11101 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11102
11103 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11104 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11105 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11106 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11107
11108 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11109 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11110 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11111 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11112 with a CPLD.
11113 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11114 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11115 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11116 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11117 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11118 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11119
11120 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11121
11122 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11123
11124 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11125 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11126 depending on the chips on your board.
11127 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11128 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11129 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11130
11131 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11132 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11133 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11134
11135 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11136 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11137 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11138 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11139
11140 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11141 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11142 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11143 this way.
11144
11145 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11146 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11147 clock rate.
11148 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11149 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11150 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11151
11152 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11153
11154 @example
11155 # Example: 1.234MHz
11156 adapter speed 1234
11157 @end example
11158
11159
11160 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11161
11162 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11163 around Windows filenames.
11164
11165 @example
11166 > echo \a
11167
11168 > echo @{\a@}
11169 \a
11170 > echo "\a"
11171
11172 >
11173 @end example
11174
11175
11176 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11177
11178 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11179 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11180 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11181
11182 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11183 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11184 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11185
11186 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11187 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11188 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11189
11190 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11191
11192 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11193 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11194 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11195 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11196
11197 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11198 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11199 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11200
11201 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11202 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11203
11204 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11205 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11206 memory read caused data abort".
11207
11208 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11209 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11210 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11211 be done, feel free to add this here.
11212
11213 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11214 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11215 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11216 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11217 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11218 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11219 gracefully stops.
11220
11221 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11222 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11223 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11224
11225 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11226 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11227 bytes. Painful...
11228
11229
11230 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11231 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11232
11233 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11234 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11235 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11236 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11237 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11238 reset, everything else should work fine.
11239
11240 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11241 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11242 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11243 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11244
11245 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11246 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11247 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11248 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11249
11250 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11251
11252 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11253 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11254 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11255
11256 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11257 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11258
11259 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11260 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11261 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11262 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11263 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11264 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11265 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11266 clock frequency?
11267
11268 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11269 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11270 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11271 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11272 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11273
11274 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11275
11276 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11277 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11278 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11279 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11280 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11281 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11282 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11283
11284 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11285
11286 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11287 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11288 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11289 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11290
11291 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11292 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11293 particular order?
11294
11295 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11296 the same order used by the hardware.
11297
11298 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11299 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11300 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11301 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11302 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11303 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11304
11305 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11306 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11307 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11308 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11309
11310 @itemize @bullet
11311 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11312 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11313 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11314 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11315 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11316 @end itemize
11317
11318 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11319
11320 @itemize @bullet
11321 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11322 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11323 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11324 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11325 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11326 @end itemize
11327
11328
11329 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11330 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11331 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11332
11333 TODO.
11334
11335 @end enumerate
11336
11337 @node Tcl Crash Course
11338 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11339 @cindex Tcl
11340
11341 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11342 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11343 how the Tcl scripts work.
11344
11345 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11346 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11347 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11348 OpenOCD.
11349
11350 @section Tcl Rule #1
11351 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11352 @enumerate
11353 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11354 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11355 @end enumerate
11356
11357 The Tcl equal is this:
11358
11359 @enumerate
11360 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11361 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11362 @end enumerate
11363
11364 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11365 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11366
11367 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11368 There is a second pair of rules.
11369 @enumerate
11370 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11371 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11372 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11373 in Tcl.
11374 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11375 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11376 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11377 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11378 @end enumerate
11379
11380 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11381 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11382 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11383 Everything is a string}
11384
11385 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11386 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11387 difference is subtle.
11388 @enumerate
11389 @item Parse Time
11390 @item Evaluation Time
11391 @end enumerate
11392
11393 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11394 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11395 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11396
11397 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11398 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11399 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11400 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11401
11402 @itemize @bullet
11403 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11404 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11405 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11406 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11407 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11408 @example
11409 # bash example
11410 X=`date`
11411 echo "The Date is: $X"
11412 # Tcl example
11413 set X [date]
11414 puts "The Date is: $X"
11415 @end example
11416 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11417 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11418 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11419 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11420 is a string}
11421 @example
11422 set x "Dinner"
11423 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11424 @end example
11425 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11426 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11427 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11428 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11429 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11430 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11431 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11432 @end itemize
11433
11434 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11435
11436 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11437
11438 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11439
11440 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11441 the normal way.
11442
11443 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11444 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11445 line is immediately executed.
11446
11447 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11448 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11449
11450 @subsection Command Execution
11451
11452 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11453 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11454 control flow operators.
11455
11456 Commands are executed like this:
11457
11458 @enumerate
11459 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11460 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11461 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11462 @end enumerate
11463
11464 It sort of works like this:
11465 @example
11466 for(;;)@{
11467 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11468
11469 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11470
11471 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11472 @}
11473 @end example
11474
11475 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11476 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11477 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11478 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11479 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11480 ``LookupCommand()''
11481
11482 @subsection The FOR command
11483
11484 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11485 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11486 command just like any other command.
11487
11488 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11489 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11490 are:
11491
11492 @enumerate 0
11493 @item The ascii text 'for'
11494 @item The start text
11495 @item The test expression
11496 @item The next text
11497 @item The body text
11498 @end enumerate
11499
11500 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11501 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11502 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11503 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11504
11505 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11506 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11507
11508 @example
11509 int
11510 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11511 int *argc,
11512 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11513 @end example
11514
11515 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11516 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11517 still operates in the same basic way.
11518
11519 @subsection FOR command implementation
11520
11521 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11522 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11523
11524 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11525
11526 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11527
11528 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11529 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11530 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11531
11532 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11533 expression and returns a value.
11534
11535 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11536 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11537 @example
11538 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11539
11540 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11541
11542 int
11543 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11544 int argc,
11545 char **argv )
11546 @{
11547 if( argc != 5 )@{
11548 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11549 return ERROR;
11550 @}
11551
11552 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11553
11554 // Execute the start statement.
11555 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11556
11557 // Top of loop test
11558 for(;;)@{
11559 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11560 if( i == 0 )
11561 break;
11562
11563 // Execute the body
11564 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11565
11566 // Execute the LOOP part
11567 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11568 @}
11569
11570 // Return no error
11571 SetResult( interp, "" );
11572 return SUCCESS;
11573 @}
11574 @end example
11575
11576 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11577 in the same basic way.
11578
11579 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11580
11581 @subsection source and find commands
11582 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11583 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11584 @*Remember the parsing rules
11585 @enumerate
11586 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11587 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11588 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11589 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11590 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11591 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11592 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11593 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11594 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11595 @end enumerate
11596 @subsection format command
11597 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11598 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11599 @b{sprintf()}.
11600 @b{Example}
11601 @example
11602 set x 6
11603 set y 7
11604 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11605 @end example
11606 @enumerate
11607 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11608 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11609 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11610 @* Refer to Rule #1
11611 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11612 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11613 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11614 @end enumerate
11615 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11616 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11617 @example
11618 #1 Good
11619 proc someproc @{@} @{
11620 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11621 @}
11622 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11623 #2 Good - no variables
11624 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11625 #3 Good Curly Braces
11626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11627 puts "Time: [date]"
11628 @}
11629 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11630 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11631 @end example
11632 @enumerate
11633 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11634 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11635 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11636 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11637 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11638 command.
11639 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11640 @*There are 4 examples:
11641 @enumerate
11642 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11643 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11644 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11645 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11646 @end enumerate
11647
11648 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11649 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11650 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11651
11652 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11653 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11654 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11655 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11656 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11657 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11658 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11659 @end enumerate
11660 @subsection Global Variables
11661 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11662 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11663 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11664 @example
11665 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11666 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11667 global x #Global variable X
11668 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11669 @}
11670 @end example
11671 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11672 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11673 @example
11674 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11675 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11676 # Create var name
11677 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11678 # Make it a global
11679 global $vn
11680 # Set it.
11681 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11682 @}
11683 @end example
11684 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11685 @example
11686 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11687 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11688 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11689 @}
11690 @end example
11691
11692 @include fdl.texi
11693
11694 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11695 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11696 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11697 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11698 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11699 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11700
11701 @printindex cp
11702
11703 @node Command and Driver Index
11704 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11705 @printindex fn
11706
11707 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)